upstream merge
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23
24 #include <config.h>
25 #include <signal.h>
26 #include <stdio.h>
27 #include <setjmp.h>
28
29 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30
31 #include "lisp.h"
32 #include "blockinput.h"
33
34 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
35 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
36 #include "syssignal.h"
37
38 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
39 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include "xterm.h"
41 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42
43 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
44 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #ifndef makedev
46 #include <sys/types.h>
47 #endif /* makedev */
48
49 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
50 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
51 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H) */
52
53 #include "systime.h"
54
55 #include <fcntl.h>
56 #include <ctype.h>
57 #include <errno.h>
58 #include <setjmp.h>
59 #include <sys/stat.h>
60 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
61 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
62
63 #include "charset.h"
64 #include "character.h"
65 #include "coding.h"
66 #include "frame.h"
67 #include "dispextern.h"
68 #include "fontset.h"
69 #include "termhooks.h"
70 #include "termopts.h"
71 #include "termchar.h"
72 #include "emacs-icon.h"
73 #include "disptab.h"
74 #include "buffer.h"
75 #include "window.h"
76 #include "keyboard.h"
77 #include "intervals.h"
78 #include "process.h"
79 #include "atimer.h"
80 #include "keymap.h"
81 #include "font.h"
82 #include "fontset.h"
83 #include "xsettings.h"
84 #include "xgselect.h"
85 #include "sysselect.h"
86
87 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
88 #include <X11/Shell.h>
89 #endif
90
91 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
92 #include <sys/time.h>
93 #endif
94 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
95 #include <unistd.h>
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_GTK
99 #include "gtkutil.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_LUCID
103 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
104 #endif
105
106 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
107 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
108 #define HACK_EDITRES
109 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
110 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
111
112 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
113
114 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
115 #if defined USE_MOTIF
116 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
117 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
118 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
119
120 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
123 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
124 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
126 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
127 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
128 #ifndef XtNpickTop
129 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
130 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
131 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
132 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
133
134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
135
136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
137 #include "widget.h"
138 #ifndef XtNinitialState
139 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
140 #endif
141 #endif
142
143 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
144 #ifdef USE_XIM
145 int use_xim = 1;
146 #else
147 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
148 #endif
149
150 \f
151
152 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
153
154 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
155
156 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
157 start. */
158
159 static int any_help_event_p;
160
161 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
162 static Lisp_Object last_window;
163
164 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
165
166 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
167
168 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
169
170 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
171
172 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
173 use. */
174
175 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
176
177 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
178 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
179 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
180 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
181
182 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
183
184 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
185 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
186 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
187 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
188
189 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
190
191 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
192
193 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
194
195 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
196
197 static struct {
198 struct frame *f;
199 int eventtype;
200 } pending_event_wait;
201
202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
203 /* The application context for Xt use. */
204 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
205 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
206 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
207
208 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
209
210 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
211
212 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
213 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
214
215 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
216
217 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
218 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
219 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
220
221 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
222
223 /* Mouse movement.
224
225 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
226 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
227 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
228 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
229
230 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
231
232 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
233 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
234 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
235 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
236 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
237 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
238 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
239 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
240 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
241 is off. */
242
243 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
244
245 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
246 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
247 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
248
249 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
250
251 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
252 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
253 an ordinary motion.
254
255 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
256 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
257 event. */
258
259 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
260
261 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
262 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
263 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
264 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
265 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
266 it's somewhat accurate. */
267
268 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
269
270 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
271
272 static Time last_user_time;
273
274 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
275 events. */
276
277 #ifdef __STDC__
278 static int volatile input_signal_count;
279 #else
280 static int input_signal_count;
281 #endif
282
283 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
284
285 static int x_noop_count;
286
287 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
288
289 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
290 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
291 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
292
293 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
294 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
295
296 #ifdef USE_GTK
297 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
298 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
299
300 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
301 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
302 #endif
303
304 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
305 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
306
307 /* Used in x_flush. */
308
309 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources (Display *, const char *, const char *,
310 const char *);
311 extern int x_bitmap_mask (FRAME_PTR, int);
312
313 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
314 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
315 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
316 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
317
318 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
319 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
320 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
322 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
323 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
324 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
325 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
326 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
327 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
329 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
330 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
331 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
332 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
333 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
334 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
335 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
336 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
337 enum text_cursor_kinds);
338
339 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
340 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
341 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
342 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
343 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
344 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
345 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
346 enum scroll_bar_part *,
347 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
348 unsigned long *);
349 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
350 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
351 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
352 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
353 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
354 int *, struct input_event *);
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358
359
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
361
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
364 {
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
369
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
372 {
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
377 }
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
381 }
382
383
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
390
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392
393 \f
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
397
398 #if 0
399
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
402
403 struct record
404 {
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
407 };
408
409 struct record event_record[100];
410
411 int event_record_index;
412
413 record_event (locus, type)
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 {
417 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
418 event_record_index = 0;
419
420 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
421 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
422 event_record_index++;
423 }
424
425 #endif /* 0 */
426
427
428 \f
429 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
430
431 struct x_display_info *
432 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
433 {
434 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
435
436 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
437 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
438 return dpyinfo;
439
440 return 0;
441 }
442
443 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
444 #define OPACITY "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY"
445
446 void
447 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
448 {
449 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
452 double alpha = 1.0;
453 double alpha_min = 1.0;
454 unsigned long opac;
455
456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
457 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
458 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
459 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
460
461 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
462 alpha = f->alpha[0];
463 else
464 alpha = f->alpha[1];
465
466 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
467 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
468 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
469 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
470
471 if (alpha < 0.0)
472 return;
473 else if (alpha > 1.0)
474 alpha = 1.0;
475 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
476 alpha = alpha_min;
477
478 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
479
480 /* return unless necessary */
481 {
482 unsigned char *data;
483 Atom actual;
484 int rc, format;
485 unsigned long n, left;
486
487 x_catch_errors (dpy);
488 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom(dpy, OPACITY, False),
489 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
490 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
491 &data);
492
493 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
494 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
495 {
496 XFree ((void *) data);
497 x_uncatch_errors ();
498 return;
499 }
500 else
501 XFree ((void *) data);
502 x_uncatch_errors ();
503 }
504
505 x_catch_errors (dpy);
506 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom (dpy, OPACITY, False),
507 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
508 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
509 x_uncatch_errors ();
510 }
511
512 int
513 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
514 {
515 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
516 }
517
518 int
519 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
520 {
521 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
522 }
523
524 \f
525 /***********************************************************************
526 Starting and ending an update
527 ***********************************************************************/
528
529 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
530 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
531 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
532 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
533 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
534
535 static void
536 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
537 {
538 /* Nothing to do. */
539 }
540
541
542 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
543 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
544 position of W. */
545
546 static void
547 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
548 {
549 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
550 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
551
552 updated_window = w;
553 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
554
555 BLOCK_INPUT;
556
557 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
558 {
559 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
560 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
561
562 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
563 highlighting. */
564 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
565 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
566 }
567
568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
569 }
570
571
572 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
573
574 static void
575 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
576 {
577 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
578 struct face *face;
579
580 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
581 if (face)
582 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
583 face->foreground);
584
585 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
586 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
587 }
588
589 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
590
591 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
592 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
593
594 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
595 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
596 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
597
598 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
599 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
600 here. */
601
602 static void
603 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
604 {
605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
606
607 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
608 {
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
610
611 if (cursor_on_p)
612 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
613 output_cursor.vpos,
614 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
615
616 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
617 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
618
619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
620 }
621
622 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
623 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
624 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
625 {
626 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
627 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
629 }
630
631 updated_window = NULL;
632 }
633
634
635 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
636 update_end. */
637
638 static void
639 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
640 {
641 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
642 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
643
644 #ifndef XFlush
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
648 #endif
649 }
650
651
652 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
653 complete update has been performed. The global variable
654 updated_window is not available here. */
655
656 static void
657 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
658 {
659 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
660 {
661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
662
663 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
664 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
665 {
666 BLOCK_INPUT;
667 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
668 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
669 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
670 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
671 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
672 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
673 }
674 }
675 }
676
677
678 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
679 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
680 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
681 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
682 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
683 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
684
685 static void
686 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
687 {
688 struct window *w = updated_window;
689 struct frame *f;
690 int width, height;
691
692 xassert (w);
693
694 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
695 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
696
697 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
698 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
699 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
700 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
701 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
702 overhead is very small. */
703 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
704 && desired_row->full_width_p
705 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
706 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
707 width != 0)
708 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
709 height > 0))
710 {
711 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
712
713 BLOCK_INPUT;
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 0, y, width, height, False);
716 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
717 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
718 y, width, height, False);
719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
720 }
721 }
722
723 static void
724 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
725 {
726 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
727 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
728 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
729 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
730 struct face *face = p->face;
731
732 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
733 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
734
735 if (!p->overlay_p)
736 {
737 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
738
739 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
740 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
741 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
742 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
743 if (face->stipple)
744 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
745 else
746 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
747
748 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
749 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
750 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
751 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
752 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
754 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
755 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
756 {
757 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
758
759 if (sb_width > 0)
760 {
761 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
762 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
763 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
764
765 if (bx < 0)
766 {
767 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
768 if (left + width == p->x)
769 bx = left + sb_width;
770 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
771 bx = left;
772 if (bx >= 0)
773 {
774 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
775
776 nx = width - sb_width;
777 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
778 row->y));
779 ny = row->visible_height;
780 }
781 }
782 else
783 {
784 if (left + width == bx)
785 {
786 bx = left + sb_width;
787 nx += width - sb_width;
788 }
789 else if (bx + nx == left)
790 nx += width - sb_width;
791 }
792 }
793 }
794 #endif
795 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
796 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
797
798 if (!face->stipple)
799 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
800 }
801
802 if (p->which)
803 {
804 unsigned char *bits;
805 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
806 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
807 XGCValues gcv;
808
809 if (p->wd > 8)
810 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
811 else
812 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
813
814 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
815 by the server. */
816 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
817 (p->cursor_p
818 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
819 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
820 : face->foreground),
821 face->background, depth);
822
823 if (p->overlay_p)
824 {
825 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
826 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
827 bits, p->wd, p->h,
828 1, 0, 1);
829 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
830 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
831 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
832 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
833 }
834
835 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
836 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
837 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
838
839 if (p->overlay_p)
840 {
841 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
842 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
843 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
844 }
845 }
846
847 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
848 }
849
850 \f
851
852 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
853 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
854 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
855 rarely happens). */
856
857 static void
858 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
859 {
860 }
861
862 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
863 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
864
865 static void
866 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
867 {
868 }
869
870 \f
871 /***********************************************************************
872 Glyph display
873 ***********************************************************************/
874
875
876
877 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
880 int);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
890 unsigned long *, double, int);
891 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
892 double, int, unsigned long);
893 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
898 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
899 int, int, int);
900 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
901 int, int, int, int, int, int,
902 XRectangle *);
903 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
905
906 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
909
910
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
913
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
916 {
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
923 {
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
927
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
930
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
942 {
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
945 }
946
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
950
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
957
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 }
960 }
961
962
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
964
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
967 {
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
970
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
976
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
983
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
987 {
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
992
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
997
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1004
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1006
1007 }
1008 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1009 }
1010
1011
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1015
1016 static INLINE void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1018 {
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1026
1027 static INLINE void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1029 {
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1031
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1033 {
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 }
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1038 {
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 }
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1043 {
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1046 }
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1048 {
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1054 {
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 }
1063
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1066 }
1067
1068
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1071
1072 static INLINE void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1074 {
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1077
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1081 }
1082
1083
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle r;
1092
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1100 }
1101
1102
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1108 {
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1112 {
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1114
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1116 {
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1120
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 else
1126 {
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1128
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1130 }
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1134 }
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1136 {
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144
1145 static INLINE void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1147 {
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1153 }
1154
1155
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1161
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1164 {
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1168 {
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1170
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1172 {
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1181 }
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1186 {
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1197
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1200 {
1201 int i, x;
1202
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1210
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1214 {
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1216 {
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 {
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1229
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1232
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1245
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1248 {
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1251
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1259
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1264
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1268 {
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1272 }
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1274 {
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1276
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1279 {
1280 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1281 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1282
1283 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1284 if (s->face->overstrike)
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1286 }
1287 }
1288 else
1289 {
1290 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1291 Lisp_Object glyph;
1292 int y = s->ybase;
1293 int width = 0;
1294
1295 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1296 {
1297 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1298 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1299 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1300 else
1301 {
1302 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1303
1304 if (j < i)
1305 {
1306 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1309 x += width;
1310 }
1311 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1312 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1313 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1314 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1315 if (s->face->overstrike)
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1317 x += wadjust;
1318 j = i + 1;
1319 width = 0;
1320 }
1321 }
1322 if (j < i)
1323 {
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1325 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1327 }
1328 }
1329 }
1330
1331
1332 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1333
1334 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1335 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1336 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1337 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1338 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1339
1340
1341 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1342 cannot be determined. */
1343
1344 static struct frame *
1345 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1346 {
1347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1348 Lisp_Object tail;
1349 struct frame *f;
1350
1351 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1352
1353 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1354 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1355 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1356 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1357 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1358 widget = XtParent (widget);
1359
1360 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1361 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1362 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1363 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1364 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1365 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1366 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1367 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1368 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1369 return f;
1370
1371 abort ();
1372 }
1373
1374
1375 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1376 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1377 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1378 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1379
1380 int
1381 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1382 {
1383 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1384 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1385 }
1386
1387
1388 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1389 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1390 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1391 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1392 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1393 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1394
1395 int
1396 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1397 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1398 {
1399 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1400 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1401 }
1402
1403
1404 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1405 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1406
1407 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1408 {
1409 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1410 sizeof (Screen *)},
1411 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1412 sizeof (Colormap)}
1413 };
1414
1415
1416 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1417 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1418
1419 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1420
1421
1422 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1423
1424 DPY is the display we are working on.
1425
1426 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1427 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1428 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1429 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1430
1431 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1432 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1433
1434 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1435 we allocated the color or not.
1436
1437 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1438
1439 static Boolean
1440 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1441 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1442 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1443 {
1444 Screen *screen;
1445 Colormap cmap;
1446 Pixel pixel;
1447 String color_name;
1448 XColor color;
1449
1450 if (*nargs != 2)
1451 {
1452 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1453 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1454 "XtToolkitError",
1455 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1456 return False;
1457 }
1458
1459 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1460 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1461 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1462
1463 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1464 {
1465 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1466 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1467 }
1468 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1469 {
1470 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1471 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1472 }
1473 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1474 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1475 {
1476 pixel = color.pixel;
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1478 }
1479 else
1480 {
1481 String params[1];
1482 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1483
1484 params[0] = color_name;
1485 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1486 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1487 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1488 params, &nparams);
1489 return False;
1490 }
1491
1492 if (to->addr != NULL)
1493 {
1494 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1495 {
1496 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1497 return False;
1498 }
1499
1500 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1501 }
1502 else
1503 {
1504 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1505 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1506 }
1507
1508 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1509 return True;
1510 }
1511
1512
1513 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1515 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1516
1517 APP is the application context in which we work.
1518
1519 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1520 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1521 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1522
1523 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1524
1525 static void
1526 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1527 Cardinal *nargs)
1528 {
1529 if (*nargs != 2)
1530 {
1531 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1532 "XtToolkitError",
1533 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1534 NULL, NULL);
1535 }
1536 else if (closure != NULL)
1537 {
1538 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1539 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1540 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1541 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1542 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1543 }
1544 }
1545
1546
1547 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1548
1549
1550 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1551 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1552 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1553 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1554
1555 static const XColor *
1556 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1557 {
1558 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1559
1560 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1561 {
1562 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1563 int i;
1564
1565 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1566 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1567 dpyinfo->color_cells
1568 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1569 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1570
1571 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1572 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1573
1574 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1575 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1576 }
1577
1578 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1579 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1580 }
1581
1582
1583 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1584 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1585
1586 void
1587 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1588 {
1589 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1590
1591 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1592 {
1593 int i;
1594 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1595 {
1596 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1597 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1598 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1599 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1600 }
1601 }
1602 else
1603 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1604 }
1605
1606
1607 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1608 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1609
1610 void
1611 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1612 {
1613 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1614 }
1615
1616
1617 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1618 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1619 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1620 allocated. */
1621
1622 static int
1623 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1624 {
1625 int rc;
1626
1627 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1628 if (rc == 0)
1629 {
1630 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1631 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1632 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1633 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1634 int nearest, i;
1635 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1636 int ncells;
1637 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1638
1639 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1640 {
1641 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1642 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1643 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1644 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1645
1646 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1647 {
1648 nearest = i;
1649 nearest_delta = delta;
1650 }
1651 }
1652
1653 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1654 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1655 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1656 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1657 }
1658 else
1659 {
1660 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1661 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1662 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1664 XColor *cached_color;
1665
1666 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1667 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1668 (cached_color->red != color->red
1669 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1670 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1671 {
1672 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1673 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1674 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1675 }
1676 }
1677
1678 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1679 if (rc)
1680 register_color (color->pixel);
1681 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1682
1683 return rc;
1684 }
1685
1686
1687 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1688 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1689 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1690 allocated. */
1691
1692 int
1693 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1694 {
1695 gamma_correct (f, color);
1696 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1697 }
1698
1699
1700 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1701 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1702 get color reference counts right. */
1703
1704 unsigned long
1705 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1706 {
1707 XColor color;
1708
1709 color.pixel = pixel;
1710 BLOCK_INPUT;
1711 x_query_color (f, &color);
1712 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1714 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1715 register_color (pixel);
1716 #endif
1717 return color.pixel;
1718 }
1719
1720
1721 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1722 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1723 get color reference counts right. */
1724
1725 unsigned long
1726 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1727 {
1728 XColor color;
1729
1730 color.pixel = pixel;
1731 BLOCK_INPUT;
1732 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1733 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1734 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1735 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1736 register_color (pixel);
1737 #endif
1738 return color.pixel;
1739 }
1740
1741
1742 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1743 boosted.
1744
1745 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1746 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1747 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1748 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1749 use an additional additive factor.
1750
1751 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1752 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1753 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1754
1755
1756 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1757 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1758 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1759 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1760 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1762
1763 static int
1764 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1765 {
1766 XColor color, new;
1767 long bright;
1768 int success_p;
1769
1770 /* Get RGB color values. */
1771 color.pixel = *pixel;
1772 x_query_color (f, &color);
1773
1774 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1775 xassert (factor >= 0);
1776 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1777 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1778 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1779
1780 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1781 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1782
1783 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1784 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1785 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1786 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1787 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1788 {
1789 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1790 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1791 /* The additive adjustment. */
1792 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1793
1794 if (factor < 1)
1795 {
1796 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1797 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1798 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1799 }
1800 else
1801 {
1802 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1803 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1804 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1805 }
1806 }
1807
1808 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1809 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1810 if (success_p)
1811 {
1812 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1813 {
1814 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1815 delta to the RGB values. */
1816 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1817
1818 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1819 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1820 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1821 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1822 }
1823 else
1824 success_p = 1;
1825 *pixel = new.pixel;
1826 }
1827
1828 return success_p;
1829 }
1830
1831
1832 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1833 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1834 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1835 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1836 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1837 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1838
1839 static void
1840 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1841 {
1842 XGCValues xgcv;
1843 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1844 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1845 unsigned long pixel;
1846 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1847 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1848 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1849 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1850
1851 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1852 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1853
1854 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1855 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1856 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1857 if (relief->gc
1858 && relief->allocated_p)
1859 {
1860 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1861 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1862 }
1863
1864 /* Allocate new color. */
1865 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1866 pixel = background;
1867 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1868 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1869 {
1870 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1871 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1872 }
1873
1874 if (relief->gc == 0)
1875 {
1876 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1877 mask |= GCStipple;
1878 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1879 }
1880 else
1881 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1882 }
1883
1884
1885 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1886
1887 static void
1888 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1889 {
1890 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long color;
1892
1893 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1894 color = s->face->box_color;
1895 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1896 && s->img->pixmap
1897 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1898 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1899 else
1900 {
1901 XGCValues xgcv;
1902
1903 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1904 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1905 color = xgcv.background;
1906 }
1907
1908 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1909 || color != di->relief_background)
1910 {
1911 di->relief_background = color;
1912 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1913 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1914 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1915 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1916 }
1917 }
1918
1919
1920 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1921 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1922 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1923 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1924 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1925 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1926 when drawing. */
1927
1928 static void
1929 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1930 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1931 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1932 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1933 {
1934 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1935 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1936 int i;
1937 GC gc;
1938
1939 if (raised_p)
1940 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1941 else
1942 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1943 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1944
1945 /* Top. */
1946 if (top_p)
1947 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1948 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1949 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1950 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1951
1952 /* Left. */
1953 if (left_p)
1954 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1955 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1956 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
1957
1958 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1959 if (raised_p)
1960 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1961 else
1962 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1963 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1964
1965 /* Bottom. */
1966 if (bot_p)
1967 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1968 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1969 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
1970 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
1971
1972 /* Right. */
1973 if (right_p)
1974 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1975 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1976 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
1977
1978 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1979 }
1980
1981
1982 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1983 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1984 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
1985 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
1986 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1987 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1988
1989 static void
1990 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
1991 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1992 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
1993 {
1994 XGCValues xgcv;
1995
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
1997 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
1998 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1999
2000 /* Top. */
2001 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2002 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2003
2004 /* Left. */
2005 if (left_p)
2006 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2007 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2008
2009 /* Bottom. */
2010 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2011 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2012
2013 /* Right. */
2014 if (right_p)
2015 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2016 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2017
2018 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2019 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2020 }
2021
2022
2023 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2027 {
2028 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2029 int left_p, right_p;
2030 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2031 XRectangle clip_rect;
2032
2033 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2034 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2035 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2036
2037 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2038 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2039 ? s->first_glyph
2040 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2041
2042 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2043 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2044 left_x = s->x;
2045 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2046 ? last_x - 1
2047 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2048 top_y = s->y;
2049 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2050
2051 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2052 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2053 && (s->prev == NULL
2054 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2055 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2056 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2057 && (s->next == NULL
2058 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2059
2060 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2061
2062 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2063 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2064 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2065 else
2066 {
2067 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2068 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2069 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2070 }
2071 }
2072
2073
2074 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2075
2076 static void
2077 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2078 {
2079 int x = s->x;
2080 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2081
2082 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2083 right of that line. */
2084 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2085 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2086 && s->slice.x == 0)
2087 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2088
2089 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2090 by that margin. */
2091 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2092 x += s->img->hmargin;
2093 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2094 y += s->img->vmargin;
2095
2096 if (s->img->pixmap)
2097 {
2098 if (s->img->mask)
2099 {
2100 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2101 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2102 trust on the shape extension to be available
2103 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2104 manually. */
2105 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2106 | GCFunction);
2107 XGCValues xgcv;
2108 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2109
2110 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2111 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2112 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2113 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2114 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2115
2116 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2117 image_rect.x = x;
2118 image_rect.y = y;
2119 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2120 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2121 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2122 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2123 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2124 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2125 }
2126 else
2127 {
2128 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2129
2130 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2131 image_rect.x = x;
2132 image_rect.y = y;
2133 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2134 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2135 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2136 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2137 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2138 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2139
2140 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2141 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2142 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2143 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2144 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2145 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2146 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2147 {
2148 int r = s->img->relief;
2149 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2150 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2151 x - r, y - r,
2152 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2153 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2154 }
2155 }
2156 }
2157 else
2158 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2159 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2160 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2161 }
2162
2163
2164 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2165
2166 static void
2167 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2168 {
2169 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2170 XRectangle r;
2171 int x = s->x;
2172 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2173
2174 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2175 right of that line. */
2176 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2177 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2178 && s->slice.x == 0)
2179 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2180
2181 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2182 by that margin. */
2183 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += s->img->hmargin;
2185 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2186 y += s->img->vmargin;
2187
2188 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2189 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2190 {
2191 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2192 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2193 }
2194 else
2195 {
2196 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2197 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2198 }
2199
2200 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2201 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2202
2203 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2204 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2205 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2206 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2207
2208 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2209 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2210 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2211 s->slice.y == 0,
2212 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2213 s->slice.x == 0,
2214 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2215 &r);
2216 }
2217
2218
2219 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2220
2221 static void
2222 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2223 {
2224 int x = 0;
2225 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2226
2227 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2228 right of that line. */
2229 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2230 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2231 && s->slice.x == 0)
2232 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2233
2234 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2235 by that margin. */
2236 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2237 x += s->img->hmargin;
2238 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2239 y += s->img->vmargin;
2240
2241 if (s->img->pixmap)
2242 {
2243 if (s->img->mask)
2244 {
2245 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2246 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2247 trust on the shape extension to be available
2248 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2249 manually. */
2250 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2251 | GCFunction);
2252 XGCValues xgcv;
2253
2254 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2255 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2256 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2257 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2258 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2259
2260 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2261 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2262 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2263 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2264 }
2265 else
2266 {
2267 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2268 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2269 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2270
2271 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2272 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2273 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2274 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2275 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2276 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2277 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2278 {
2279 int r = s->img->relief;
2280 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2281 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2282 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2283 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2284 }
2285 }
2286 }
2287 else
2288 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2289 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2290 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2291 }
2292
2293
2294 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2295 give the rectangle to draw. */
2296
2297 static void
2298 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2299 {
2300 if (s->stippled_p)
2301 {
2302 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2303 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2304 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2305 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2306 }
2307 else
2308 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2309 }
2310
2311
2312 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2313
2314 s->y
2315 s->x +-------------------------
2316 | s->face->box
2317 |
2318 | +-------------------------
2319 | | s->img->margin
2320 | |
2321 | | +-------------------
2322 | | | the image
2323
2324 */
2325
2326 static void
2327 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2328 {
2329 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2330 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2331 int height;
2332 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2333
2334 height = s->height;
2335 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2336 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2337 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2338 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2339
2340 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2341 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2342 flickering. */
2343 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2344 if (height > s->slice.height
2345 || s->img->hmargin
2346 || s->img->vmargin
2347 || s->img->mask
2348 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2349 || s->width != s->background_width)
2350 {
2351 if (s->img->mask)
2352 {
2353 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2354 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2355 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2356 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2357 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2358
2359 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2360 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2361 s->background_width,
2362 s->height, depth);
2363
2364 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2365 pixmap. */
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367
2368 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2369 if (s->stippled_p)
2370 {
2371 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2372 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2373 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2374 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2375 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2376 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2377 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2378 }
2379 else
2380 {
2381 XGCValues xgcv;
2382 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2383 &xgcv);
2384 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2385 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2386 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2387 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 {
2392 int x = s->x;
2393 int y = s->y;
2394
2395 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2396 && s->slice.x == 0)
2397 x += box_line_hwidth;
2398
2399 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2400 y += box_line_vwidth;
2401
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2403 }
2404
2405 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2406 }
2407
2408 /* Draw the foreground. */
2409 if (pixmap != None)
2410 {
2411 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2412 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2413 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2414 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2415 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2416 }
2417 else
2418 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2419
2420 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2421 if (s->img->relief
2422 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2423 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2424 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2425 }
2426
2427
2428 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2429
2430 static void
2431 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2432 {
2433 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2434
2435 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2436 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2437 {
2438 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2439 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2440 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2441 int x = s->x;
2442
2443 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2444 {
2445 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2446
2447 if (x < left_x)
2448 {
2449 background_width -= left_x - x;
2450 x = left_x;
2451 }
2452 }
2453 else
2454 {
2455 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2456 stretch glyph. */
2457 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2458
2459 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2460 background_width -= x - right_x;
2461 x += background_width;
2462 }
2463 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2464 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2465 x -= width;
2466
2467 /* Draw cursor. */
2468 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2469
2470 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2471 if (width < background_width)
2472 {
2473 int y = s->y;
2474 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2475 XRectangle r;
2476 GC gc;
2477
2478 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2479 x += width;
2480 else
2481 x = s->x;
2482 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2483 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2484 {
2485 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2486 gc = s->gc;
2487 }
2488 else
2489 gc = s->face->gc;
2490
2491 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2492 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2493
2494 if (s->face->stipple)
2495 {
2496 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2497 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2498 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2500 }
2501 else
2502 {
2503 XGCValues xgcv;
2504 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2505 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2506 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2508 }
2509 }
2510 }
2511 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2512 {
2513 int background_width = s->background_width;
2514 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2515
2516 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2517 except for header line and mode line. */
2518 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2519 {
2520 background_width -= left_x - x;
2521 x = left_x;
2522 }
2523 if (background_width > 0)
2524 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2525 }
2526
2527 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2528 }
2529
2530
2531 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2532
2533 static void
2534 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2535 {
2536 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2537
2538 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2539 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2540 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2541 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2542 {
2543 int width;
2544 struct glyph_string *next;
2545
2546 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2547 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2548 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2549 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2550 {
2551 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2552 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2553 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2554 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2555 else
2556 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2557 next->num_clips = 0;
2558 }
2559 }
2560
2561 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2562 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2563
2564 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2565 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2566 if (!s->for_overlaps
2567 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2568 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2569 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2570
2571 {
2572 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2573 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2574 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2575 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2576 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2577 }
2578 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2579 && !s->clip_tail
2580 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2581 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2582 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2583 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2584 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2585 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2586 else
2587 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2588
2589 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2590 {
2591 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2592 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2593 break;
2594
2595 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2596 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2597 break;
2598
2599 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2600 if (s->for_overlaps)
2601 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2602 else
2603 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2604 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2605 break;
2606
2607 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2608 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2609 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2610 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2611 else
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2613 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2614 break;
2615
2616 default:
2617 abort ();
2618 }
2619
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2621 {
2622 /* Draw underline. */
2623 if (s->face->underline_p)
2624 {
2625 unsigned long thickness, position;
2626 int y;
2627
2628 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2629 {
2630 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2631 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2632 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2633 }
2634 else
2635 {
2636 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2637 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2638 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2639 else
2640 thickness = 1;
2641 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2642 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2643 else
2644 {
2645 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2646 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2647 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2648 specs, and its default is
2649
2650 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2651 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2652
2653 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2654 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2655 position = s->font->underline_position;
2656 else if (s->font)
2657 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2658 else
2659 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2660 }
2661 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2662 }
2663 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2664 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2665 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2666 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2667 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2668 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2669 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2670 s->underline_position = position;
2671 y = s->ybase + position;
2672 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2673 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2674 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2675 else
2676 {
2677 XGCValues xgcv;
2678 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2679 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2680 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2681 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2682 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2683 }
2684 }
2685
2686 /* Draw overline. */
2687 if (s->face->overline_p)
2688 {
2689 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2690
2691 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2692 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2693 s->width, h);
2694 else
2695 {
2696 XGCValues xgcv;
2697 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2698 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2699 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2700 s->width, h);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2702 }
2703 }
2704
2705 /* Draw strike-through. */
2706 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2707 {
2708 unsigned long h = 1;
2709 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2710
2711 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2712 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2713 s->width, h);
2714 else
2715 {
2716 XGCValues xgcv;
2717 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2718 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2719 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2720 s->width, h);
2721 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2722 }
2723 }
2724
2725 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2726 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2728
2729 if (s->prev)
2730 {
2731 struct glyph_string *prev;
2732
2733 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2734 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2735 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2736 {
2737 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2738 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2739 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2740
2741 prev->hl = s->hl;
2742 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2744 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2745 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2746 else
2747 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2748 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2749 prev->hl = save;
2750 prev->num_clips = 0;
2751 }
2752 }
2753
2754 if (s->next)
2755 {
2756 struct glyph_string *next;
2757
2758 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2759 if (next->hl != s->hl
2760 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2761 {
2762 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2763 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2764 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2765
2766 next->hl = s->hl;
2767 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2768 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2769 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2770 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2771 else
2772 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2773 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2774 next->hl = save;
2775 next->num_clips = 0;
2776 }
2777 }
2778 }
2779
2780 /* Reset clipping. */
2781 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2782 s->num_clips = 0;
2783 }
2784
2785 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2786
2787 void
2788 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2789 {
2790 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2791 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2792 x, y, width, height,
2793 x + shift_by, y);
2794 }
2795
2796 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2797 for X frames. */
2798
2799 static void
2800 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2801 {
2802 abort ();
2803 }
2804
2805
2806 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2807 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2808
2809 void
2810 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2811 {
2812 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2813 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2814 }
2815
2816
2817 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2818
2819 static void
2820 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2821 {
2822 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2823 longer visible. */
2824 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2825 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2826 output_cursor.x = -1;
2827
2828 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2829 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2830 BLOCK_INPUT;
2831 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2832
2833 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2834 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2835 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2836
2837 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2838 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2839 redisplay, do it here. */
2840 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2841 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2842 #endif
2843
2844 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2845
2846 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2847 }
2848
2849
2850 \f
2851 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2852
2853 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2854 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2855
2856 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2857
2858
2859 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2860 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2861
2862 static int
2863 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2864 {
2865 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2866 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2867 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2868 {
2869 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2870 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2871 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2872 }
2873
2874 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2875 {
2876 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2877 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2878 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2879 }
2880
2881 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2882 positive. */
2883 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2884 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2885
2886 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2887 negative. */
2888 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2889 }
2890
2891 void
2892 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2893 {
2894 BLOCK_INPUT;
2895
2896 {
2897 #ifdef USE_GTK
2898 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2899 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2900 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2901 GdkGCValues vals;
2902 GdkGC *gc;
2903 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2904 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2905 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
2906 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
2907 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
2908 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
2909 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
2910 #else
2911 GC gc;
2912
2913 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2914 pixels into background pixels. */
2915 {
2916 XGCValues values;
2917
2918 values.function = GXxor;
2919 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2920 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2921
2922 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2923 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2924 }
2925 #endif
2926 {
2927 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2928 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2929 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2930 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2931 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2932 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2933 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2934
2935 int width;
2936
2937 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2938 edge it is next to. */
2939 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2940 {
2941 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2942 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2943 break;
2944
2945 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2946 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2947 break;
2948
2949 default:
2950 break;
2951 }
2952
2953 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2954
2955 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2956 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2957 {
2958 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2959 flash_left,
2960 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2961 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
2962 width, flash_height);
2963 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2964 flash_left,
2965 (height - flash_height
2966 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2967 width, flash_height);
2968
2969 }
2970 else
2971 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2972 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2973 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2974 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2975
2976 x_flush (f);
2977
2978 {
2979 struct timeval wakeup;
2980
2981 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2982
2983 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2984 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2985 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2986 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2987
2988 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2989 available. */
2990 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2991 {
2992 struct timeval current;
2993 struct timeval timeout;
2994
2995 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2996
2997 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2998 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2999 break;
3000
3001 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3002 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3003 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3004
3005 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3006 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3007 }
3008 }
3009
3010 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3011 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3012 {
3013 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3014 flash_left,
3015 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3016 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3017 width, flash_height);
3018 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3019 flash_left,
3020 (height - flash_height
3021 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3022 width, flash_height);
3023 }
3024 else
3025 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3026 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3027 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3028 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3029
3030 #ifdef USE_GTK
3031 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3032 #undef XFillRectangle
3033 #else
3034 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3035 #endif
3036 x_flush (f);
3037 }
3038 }
3039
3040 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3041 }
3042
3043 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3044
3045
3046 static void
3047 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3048 {
3049 BLOCK_INPUT;
3050 if (invisible)
3051 {
3052 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3053 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3054 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3055 }
3056 else
3057 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3058 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3059 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3061 }
3062
3063
3064 /* Make audible bell. */
3065
3066 void
3067 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3068 {
3069 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3070 {
3071 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3072 if (visible_bell)
3073 XTflash (f);
3074 else
3075 #endif
3076 {
3077 BLOCK_INPUT;
3078 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3079 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3080 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3081 }
3082 }
3083 }
3084
3085 \f
3086 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3087 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3088 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3089 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3090
3091 static void
3092 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3093 {
3094 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3095 }
3096
3097
3098 \f
3099 /***********************************************************************
3100 Line Dance
3101 ***********************************************************************/
3102
3103 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3104 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3105
3106 static void
3107 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3108 {
3109 abort ();
3110 }
3111
3112
3113 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3114
3115 static void
3116 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3117 {
3118 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3119 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3120
3121 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3122 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3123 fringe of W. */
3124 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3125
3126 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3127 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3128 bottom_y = y + height;
3129
3130 if (to_y < from_y)
3131 {
3132 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3133 line at the bottom. */
3134 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3135 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3136 else
3137 height = run->height;
3138 }
3139 else
3140 {
3141 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3142 at the bottom. */
3143 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3144 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3145 else
3146 height = run->height;
3147 }
3148
3149 BLOCK_INPUT;
3150
3151 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3152 updated_window = w;
3153 x_clear_cursor (w);
3154
3155 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3156 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3157 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3158 x, from_y,
3159 width, height,
3160 x, to_y);
3161
3162 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3163 }
3164
3165
3166 \f
3167 /***********************************************************************
3168 Exposure Events
3169 ***********************************************************************/
3170
3171 \f
3172 static void
3173 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3174 {
3175 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3176 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3177 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3178 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3179 BLOCK_INPUT;
3180 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3181 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3183 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3184 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3185 }
3186
3187 static void
3188 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3189 {
3190 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3191 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3192 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3193 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3194 BLOCK_INPUT;
3195 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3196 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3197 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3198 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3199 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3200 }
3201
3202 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3203 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3204 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3205 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3206 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3207
3208 static void
3209 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3210 {
3211 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3212
3213 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3214 {
3215 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3216 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3217 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3218
3219 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3220 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3221
3222 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3223 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3224 else
3225 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3226 }
3227
3228 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3229 }
3230
3231 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3232 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3233 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3234
3235 static void
3236 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3237 {
3238 if (type == FocusIn)
3239 {
3240 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3241 {
3242 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3243 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3244
3245 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3246 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3247 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3248 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3249 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3250 {
3251 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3252 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3253 }
3254 }
3255
3256 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3257
3258 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3259 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3260 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3261 #endif
3262 }
3263 else if (type == FocusOut)
3264 {
3265 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3266
3267 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3268 {
3269 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3270 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3271 }
3272
3273 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3274 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3275 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3276 #endif
3277 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3278 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3279 }
3280 }
3281
3282 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3283 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3284
3285 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3286
3287 static void
3288 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3289 {
3290 struct frame *frame;
3291
3292 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3293 if (! frame)
3294 return;
3295
3296 switch (event->type)
3297 {
3298 case EnterNotify:
3299 case LeaveNotify:
3300 {
3301 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3302 int focus_state
3303 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3304
3305 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3306 && event->xcrossing.focus
3307 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3308 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3309 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3310 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3311 }
3312 break;
3313
3314 case FocusIn:
3315 case FocusOut:
3316 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3317 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3318 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3319 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3320 break;
3321
3322 case ClientMessage:
3323 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3324 {
3325 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3326 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3327 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3328 }
3329 break;
3330 }
3331 }
3332
3333
3334 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3335
3336 void
3337 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3338 {
3339 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3340 }
3341
3342 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3343 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3344 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3345
3346 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3347 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3348 the appropriate X display info. */
3349
3350 static void
3351 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3352 {
3353 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3354 }
3355
3356 static void
3357 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3358 {
3359 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3360
3361 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3362 {
3363 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3364 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3365 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3366 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3367 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3368 {
3369 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3370 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3371 }
3372 }
3373 else
3374 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3375
3376 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3377 {
3378 if (old_highlight)
3379 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3380 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3381 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3382 }
3383 }
3384
3385
3386 \f
3387 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3388
3389 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3390 static void
3391 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3392 {
3393 int min_code, max_code;
3394 KeySym *syms;
3395 int syms_per_code;
3396 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3397
3398 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3399 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3400 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3401 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3402 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3403
3404 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3405
3406 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3407 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3408 &syms_per_code);
3409 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3410
3411 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3412 Alt keysyms are on. */
3413 {
3414 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3415 int found_alt_or_meta;
3416
3417 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3418 {
3419 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3420 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3421 {
3422 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3423
3424 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3425 if (code == 0)
3426 continue;
3427
3428 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3429 {
3430 int code_col;
3431
3432 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3433 {
3434 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3435
3436 switch (sym)
3437 {
3438 case XK_Meta_L:
3439 case XK_Meta_R:
3440 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3441 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3442 break;
3443
3444 case XK_Alt_L:
3445 case XK_Alt_R:
3446 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3447 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3448 break;
3449
3450 case XK_Hyper_L:
3451 case XK_Hyper_R:
3452 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3453 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3454 code_col = syms_per_code;
3455 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3456 break;
3457
3458 case XK_Super_L:
3459 case XK_Super_R:
3460 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3461 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3462 code_col = syms_per_code;
3463 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3464 break;
3465
3466 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3467 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3468 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3469 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3470 code_col = syms_per_code;
3471 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3472 break;
3473 }
3474 }
3475 }
3476 }
3477 }
3478 }
3479
3480 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3481 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3482 {
3483 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3484 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3485 }
3486
3487 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3488 make them just meta, not alt. */
3489 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3490 {
3491 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3492 }
3493
3494 XFree ((char *) syms);
3495 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3496 }
3497
3498 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3499 Emacs uses. */
3500
3501 unsigned int
3502 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3503 {
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3505 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3506 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3507 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3508 Lisp_Object tem;
3509
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3516 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3517 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3518
3519
3520 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3521 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3522 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3523 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3524 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3525 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3526 }
3527
3528 static unsigned int
3529 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3530 {
3531 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3532 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3533 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3534 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3535
3536 Lisp_Object tem;
3537
3538 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3539 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3540 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3541 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3542 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3543 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3544 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3545 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3546
3547
3548 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3549 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3550 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3551 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3552 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3553 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3554 }
3555
3556 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3557
3558 char *
3559 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3560 {
3561 char *value;
3562
3563 BLOCK_INPUT;
3564 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3565 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3566
3567 return value;
3568 }
3569
3570
3571 \f
3572 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3573
3574 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3575
3576 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3577 the mouse. */
3578
3579 static Lisp_Object
3580 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3581 {
3582 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3583 otherwise. */
3584 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3585 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3586 result->timestamp = event->time;
3587 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3588 event->state)
3589 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3590 ? up_modifier
3591 : down_modifier));
3592
3593 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3594 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3595 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3596 result->arg = Qnil;
3597 return Qnil;
3598 }
3599
3600 \f
3601 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3602 The input handler calls this.
3603
3604 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3605 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3606 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3607 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3608
3609 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3610 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3611
3612 static int
3613 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3614 {
3615 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3616 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3617 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3618
3619 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3620 return 0;
3621
3622 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3623 {
3624 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3625 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3626 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3627 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3628 return 1;
3629 }
3630
3631
3632 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3633 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3634 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3635 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3636 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3637 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3638 {
3639 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3640 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3641 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3642 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3643 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3644 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3645 return 1;
3646 }
3647
3648 return 0;
3649 }
3650
3651 \f
3652 /************************************************************************
3653 Mouse Face
3654 ************************************************************************/
3655
3656 static void
3657 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3658 {
3659 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3660 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3661 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3662 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3663 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3664 }
3665
3666
3667
3668 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3669 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3670
3671 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3672 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3673 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3674 position on the scroll bar.
3675
3676 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3677 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3678 the mouse is over.
3679
3680 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3681 was at this position.
3682
3683 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3684
3685 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3686 movement. */
3687
3688 static void
3689 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3690 {
3691 FRAME_PTR f1;
3692
3693 BLOCK_INPUT;
3694
3695 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3696 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3697 else
3698 {
3699 Window root;
3700 int root_x, root_y;
3701
3702 Window dummy_window;
3703 int dummy;
3704
3705 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3706
3707 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3708 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3709 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3710 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3711 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3712
3713 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3714
3715 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3716 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3717 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3718
3719 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3720 &root,
3721
3722 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3723 a different screen. */
3724 &dummy_window,
3725
3726 /* The position on that root window. */
3727 &root_x, &root_y,
3728
3729 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3730 &dummy, &dummy,
3731
3732 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3733 we don't care. */
3734 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3735
3736 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3737 containing the pointer. */
3738 {
3739 Window win, child;
3740 int win_x, win_y;
3741 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3742
3743 win = root;
3744
3745 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3746 structure is changing at the same time this function
3747 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3748
3749 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3750
3751 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3752 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3753 {
3754 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3755 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3756 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3757
3758 /* From-window, to-window. */
3759 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3760
3761 /* From-position, to-position. */
3762 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3763
3764 /* Child of win. */
3765 &child);
3766 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3767 }
3768 else
3769 {
3770 while (1)
3771 {
3772 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3773
3774 /* From-window, to-window. */
3775 root, win,
3776
3777 /* From-position, to-position. */
3778 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3779
3780 /* Child of win. */
3781 &child);
3782
3783 if (child == None || child == win)
3784 break;
3785 #ifdef USE_GTK
3786 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3787 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3788 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3789 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3790 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3791 break;
3792 #endif
3793 win = child;
3794 parent_x = win_x;
3795 parent_y = win_y;
3796 }
3797
3798 /* Now we know that:
3799 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3800 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3801 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3802 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3803 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3804 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3805 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3806 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3807 never use them in that case.) */
3808
3809 #ifdef USE_GTK
3810 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3811 want the edit window. */
3812 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3813 #else
3814 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3815 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3816 #endif
3817
3818 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3819 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3820 on the frame. */
3821 if (f1 != NULL
3822 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3823 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3824 f1 = NULL;
3825 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3826 }
3827
3828 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3829 f1 = 0;
3830
3831 x_uncatch_errors ();
3832
3833 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3834 if (! f1)
3835 {
3836 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3837
3838 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3839
3840 if (bar)
3841 {
3842 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3843 win_x = parent_x;
3844 win_y = parent_y;
3845 }
3846 }
3847
3848 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3849 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3850
3851 if (f1)
3852 {
3853 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3854 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3855 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3856 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3857 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3858 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3859 the frame are divided into. */
3860
3861 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3862 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3863
3864 *bar_window = Qnil;
3865 *part = 0;
3866 *fp = f1;
3867 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3868 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3869 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3870 }
3871 }
3872 }
3873
3874 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3875 }
3876
3877
3878 \f
3879 /***********************************************************************
3880 Scroll bars
3881 ***********************************************************************/
3882
3883 /* Scroll bar support. */
3884
3885 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3886 manages it.
3887 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3888 bits. */
3889
3890 static struct scroll_bar *
3891 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
3892 {
3893 Lisp_Object tail;
3894
3895 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3896 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3897 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3898
3899 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3900 {
3901 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3902
3903 frame = XCAR (tail);
3904 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3905 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
3906 abort ();
3907
3908 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
3909 continue;
3910
3911 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3912 right window ID. */
3913 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3914 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3915 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3916 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3917 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3918 condemned = Qnil,
3919 ! NILP (bar));
3920 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3921 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
3922 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3923 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3924 }
3925
3926 return 0;
3927 }
3928
3929
3930 #if defined USE_LUCID
3931
3932 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3933 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3934
3935 static Widget
3936 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
3937 {
3938 Lisp_Object tail;
3939
3940 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3941 {
3942 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
3943 {
3944 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3945 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3946
3947 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3948 return menu_bar;
3949 }
3950 }
3951
3952 return NULL;
3953 }
3954
3955 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3956
3957 \f
3958 /************************************************************************
3959 Toolkit scroll bars
3960 ************************************************************************/
3961
3962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3963
3964 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
3965 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
3966 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
3967 struct scroll_bar *);
3968 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
3969 int, int, int);
3970
3971
3972 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3973 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3974
3975 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3976
3977 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3978
3979 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3980
3981 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3982 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3983
3984 #ifndef USE_GTK
3985 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3986
3987 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3988
3989 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3990
3991 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3992 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3993 to avoid jerkyness. */
3994
3995 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3996
3997 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3998 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3999 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4000 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4001
4002 static void
4003 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4004 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4005 {
4006 int scroll_bar_p;
4007 char *end_action;
4008
4009 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4010 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4011 end_action = "Release";
4012 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4013 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4014 end_action = "EndScroll";
4015 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4016
4017 if (scroll_bar_p
4018 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4019 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4020 {
4021 struct window *w;
4022
4023 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4024 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4025 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4026
4027 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4028 {
4029 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4030 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4031 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4032 }
4033 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4034 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4035
4036 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4037 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4038 }
4039 }
4040 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4041
4042 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4043 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4044
4045 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4046 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4047
4048
4049 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4050 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4051 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4052 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4053
4054 static void
4055 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4056 {
4057 XEvent event;
4058 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4059 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4060 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4061 int i;
4062
4063 BLOCK_INPUT;
4064
4065 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4066 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4067 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4068 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4069 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4070 ev->format = 32;
4071
4072 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4073 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4074 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4075 into that array in the event. */
4076 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4077 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4078 break;
4079
4080 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4081 {
4082 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4083 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4084 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4085
4086 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4087 nbytes);
4088 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4089 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4090 }
4091
4092 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4093 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4094 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4095 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4096 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4097 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4098
4099 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4100 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4102 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4103 #endif
4104
4105 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4106 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4107 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4108 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4109 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4110 }
4111
4112
4113 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4114 in *IEVENT. */
4115
4116 static void
4117 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4118 {
4119 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4120 Lisp_Object window;
4121 struct frame *f;
4122 struct window *w;
4123
4124 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4125 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4126
4127 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4128 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4129
4130 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4131 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4132 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4133 #ifdef USE_GTK
4134 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4135 #else
4136 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4137 #endif
4138 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4139 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4140 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4141 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4142 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4143 }
4144
4145
4146 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4147
4148 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4149
4150 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4151
4152
4153 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4154 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4155 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4156
4157 static void
4158 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4159 {
4160 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4161 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4162 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4163
4164 switch (cs->reason)
4165 {
4166 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4167 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4168 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4169 break;
4170
4171 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4172 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4173 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4174 break;
4175
4176 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4177 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4178 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4179 break;
4180
4181 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4182 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4183 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4184 break;
4185
4186 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4187 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4188 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4189 break;
4190
4191 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4192 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4193 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4194 break;
4195
4196 case XmCR_DRAG:
4197 {
4198 int slider_size;
4199
4200 /* Get the slider size. */
4201 BLOCK_INPUT;
4202 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4203 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4204
4205 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4206 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4207 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4208 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4209 }
4210 break;
4211
4212 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4213 break;
4214 };
4215
4216 if (part >= 0)
4217 {
4218 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4219 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4220 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4221 }
4222 }
4223
4224 #elif defined USE_GTK
4225
4226 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4227 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4228
4229 static gboolean
4230 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4231 GtkScrollType scroll,
4232 gdouble value,
4233 gpointer user_data)
4234 {
4235 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4236 gdouble position;
4237 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4238 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4239 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4240
4241 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4242 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4243
4244
4245 switch (scroll)
4246 {
4247 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4248 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4249 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4250 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4251 {
4252 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4253 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4254 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4255 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4256 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4257 }
4258 break;
4259 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4260 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4261 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4262 break;
4263 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4264 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4265 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4266 break;
4267 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4268 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4269 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4270 break;
4271 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4272 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4273 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4274 break;
4275 }
4276
4277 if (part >= 0)
4278 {
4279 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4280 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4281 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4282 }
4283
4284 return FALSE;
4285 }
4286
4287 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4288
4289 static gboolean
4290 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4291 GdkEventButton *event,
4292 gpointer user_data)
4293 {
4294 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4295 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4296 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4297 {
4298 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4299 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4300 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4301 }
4302
4303 return FALSE;
4304 }
4305
4306
4307 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4308
4309 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4310 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4311 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4312 the thumb is. */
4313
4314 static void
4315 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4316 {
4317 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4318 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4319 float shown;
4320 int whole, portion, height;
4321 int part;
4322
4323 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4324 BLOCK_INPUT;
4325 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4327
4328 whole = 10000000;
4329 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4330
4331 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4332 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4333 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4334 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4335 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4336 bottom). */
4337 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4338 else
4339 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4340
4341 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4342 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4343 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4344 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4345 }
4346
4347
4348 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4349 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4350 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4351 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4352 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4353 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4354 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4355
4356 static void
4357 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4358 {
4359 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4360 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4361 int position = (long) call_data;
4362 Dimension height;
4363 int part;
4364
4365 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4366 BLOCK_INPUT;
4367 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4369
4370 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4371 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4372
4373 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4374 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4375 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4376 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4377 else
4378 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4379
4380 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4381 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4382 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4383 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4384 }
4385
4386 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4387
4388 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4389
4390 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4391 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4392
4393 #ifdef USE_GTK
4394 static void
4395 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4396 {
4397 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4398
4399 BLOCK_INPUT;
4400 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4401 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4402 scroll_bar_name);
4403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4404 }
4405
4406 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4407
4408 static void
4409 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4410 {
4411 Window xwindow;
4412 Widget widget;
4413 Arg av[20];
4414 int ac = 0;
4415 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4416 unsigned long pixel;
4417
4418 BLOCK_INPUT;
4419
4420 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4421 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4422 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4425 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4426 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4427 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4429
4430 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4431 if (pixel != -1)
4432 {
4433 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4434 ++ac;
4435 }
4436
4437 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4438 if (pixel != -1)
4439 {
4440 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4441 ++ac;
4442 }
4443
4444 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4445 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4446
4447 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4448 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4449 (XtPointer) bar);
4450 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4451 (XtPointer) bar);
4452 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4453 (XtPointer) bar);
4454 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4455 (XtPointer) bar);
4456 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4457 (XtPointer) bar);
4458 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4459 (XtPointer) bar);
4460 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4461 (XtPointer) bar);
4462
4463 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4464 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4465
4466 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4467 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4468 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4469 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4470
4471 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4472
4473 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4474 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4475 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4476 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4477 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4478 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4479 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4480 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4481
4482 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4483 if (pixel != -1)
4484 {
4485 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4486 ++ac;
4487 }
4488
4489 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4490 if (pixel != -1)
4491 {
4492 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4493 ++ac;
4494 }
4495
4496 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4497
4498 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4499 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4500 {
4501 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4502 if (pixel != -1)
4503 {
4504 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4505 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4506 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4507 pixel = -1;
4508 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4509 }
4510 }
4511 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4512 {
4513 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4514 if (pixel != -1)
4515 {
4516 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4517 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4518 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4519 pixel = -1;
4520 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4521 }
4522 }
4523
4524 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4525 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4526 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4527 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4528 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4529 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4530 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4531 colors itself. */
4532 {
4533 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4534 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4535 ++ac;
4536 }
4537 else
4538 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4539 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4540 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4541 {
4542 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4543 the shadows. */
4544 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4545 ++ac;
4546
4547 /* Specify the colors. */
4548 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4549 if (pixel != -1)
4550 {
4551 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4552 ++ac;
4553 }
4554 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4555 if (pixel != -1)
4556 {
4557 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4558 ++ac;
4559 }
4560 }
4561 #endif
4562
4563 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4564 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4565
4566 {
4567 char *initial = "";
4568 char *val = initial;
4569 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4570 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4571 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4572 #endif
4573 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4574 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4575 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4576 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4577 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4578 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4579 }
4580 }
4581
4582 /* Define callbacks. */
4583 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4584 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4585 (XtPointer) bar);
4586
4587 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4588 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4589
4590 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4591
4592 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4593 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4594 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4595 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4596
4597 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4598 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4599 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4600 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4601
4602 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4603 }
4604 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4605
4606
4607 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4608 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4609
4610 #ifdef USE_GTK
4611 static void
4612 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4613 {
4614 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4615 }
4616
4617 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4618 static void
4619 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4620 int whole)
4621 {
4622 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4623 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4624 float top, shown;
4625
4626 BLOCK_INPUT;
4627
4628 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4629
4630 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4631 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4632 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4633 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4634 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4635 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4636 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4637 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4638 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4639 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4640 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4641 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4642 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4643 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4644 whole += portion;
4645
4646 if (whole <= 0)
4647 top = 0, shown = 1;
4648 else
4649 {
4650 top = (float) position / whole;
4651 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4652 }
4653
4654 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4655 {
4656 int size, value;
4657
4658 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4659 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4660 value. */
4661 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4662 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4663 size = max (size, 1);
4664
4665 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4666 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4667 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4668
4669 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4670 }
4671 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4672
4673 if (whole == 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4676 {
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4679 }
4680
4681 {
4682 float old_top, old_shown;
4683 Dimension height;
4684 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4685 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4686 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4687 XtNheight, &height,
4688 NULL);
4689
4690 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4691 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4692 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4693 else
4694 top = old_top;
4695 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4696 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4697
4698 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4699 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4700 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4701 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4702 {
4703 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4704 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4705 else
4706 {
4707 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4708 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4709 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4710
4711 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4712 }
4713 }
4714 }
4715 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4716
4717 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4718 }
4719 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4720
4721 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4722
4723
4724 \f
4725 /************************************************************************
4726 Scroll bars, general
4727 ************************************************************************/
4728
4729 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4730 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4731 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4732 scroll bar. */
4733
4734 static struct scroll_bar *
4735 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4736 {
4737 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4738 struct scroll_bar *bar
4739 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4740
4741 BLOCK_INPUT;
4742
4743 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4744 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4745 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4746 {
4747 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4748 unsigned long mask;
4749 Window window;
4750
4751 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4752 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4753 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4754
4755 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4756 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4757 | ExposureMask);
4758 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4759
4760 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4761
4762 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4763 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4764 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4765 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4766 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4767 left, top, width,
4768 window_box_height (w), False);
4769
4770 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4771 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4772 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4773 top,
4774 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4775 height,
4776 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4777 0,
4778 CopyFromParent,
4779 CopyFromParent,
4780 CopyFromParent,
4781 /* Attributes. */
4782 mask, &a);
4783 bar->x_window = window;
4784 }
4785 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4786
4787 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4788 bar->top = top;
4789 bar->left = left;
4790 bar->width = width;
4791 bar->height = height;
4792 bar->start = 0;
4793 bar->end = 0;
4794 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4795 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4796
4797 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4798 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4799 bar->prev = Qnil;
4800 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4801 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4802 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4803
4804 /* Map the window/widget. */
4805 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4806 {
4807 #ifdef USE_GTK
4808 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4809 bar->x_window,
4810 top,
4811 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4812 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4813 max (height, 1));
4814 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4815 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4816 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4817 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4818 top,
4819 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4820 max (height, 1), 0);
4821 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4822 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4823 }
4824 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4825 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4826 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4827
4828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4829 return bar;
4830 }
4831
4832
4833 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4834
4835 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4836
4837 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4838 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4839 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4840 events.)
4841
4842 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4843 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4844 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4845 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4846 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4847
4848 static void
4849 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4850 {
4851 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4852 Window w = bar->x_window;
4853 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4854 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4855
4856 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4857 if (! rebuild
4858 && start == bar->start
4859 && end == bar->end)
4860 return;
4861
4862 BLOCK_INPUT;
4863
4864 {
4865 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4866 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4867 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4868
4869 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4870 the distance between start and end. */
4871 {
4872 int length = end - start;
4873
4874 if (start < 0)
4875 start = 0;
4876 else if (start > top_range)
4877 start = top_range;
4878 end = start + length;
4879
4880 if (end < start)
4881 end = start;
4882 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4883 end = top_range;
4884 }
4885
4886 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4887 bar->start = start;
4888 bar->end = end;
4889
4890 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4891 if (end > top_range)
4892 end = top_range;
4893
4894 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4895 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4896 that many pixels tall. */
4897 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4898
4899 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4900 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4901 if (0 < start)
4902 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4903 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4905 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4906 inside_width, start,
4907 False);
4908
4909 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4910 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4911 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4912 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4913
4914 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4915 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4916 /* x, y, width, height */
4917 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4918 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4919 inside_width, end - start);
4920
4921 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4922 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4923 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4924 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
4925
4926 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4927 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4928 if (end < inside_height)
4929 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4930 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4931 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4932 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4933 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4934 False);
4935
4936 }
4937
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4939 }
4940
4941 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4942
4943 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4944 nil. */
4945
4946 static void
4947 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
4948 {
4949 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4950 BLOCK_INPUT;
4951
4952 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4953 #ifdef USE_GTK
4954 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
4955 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4956 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4957 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4958 #else
4959 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4960 #endif
4961
4962 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4963 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4964
4965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4966 }
4967
4968
4969 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4970 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4971 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4972 create one. */
4973
4974 static void
4975 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
4976 {
4977 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4978 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4979 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4980 int window_y, window_height;
4981 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4982 int fringe_extended_p;
4983 #endif
4984
4985 /* Get window dimensions. */
4986 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4987 top = window_y;
4988 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4989 height = window_height;
4990
4991 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4992 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4993
4994 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4995 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4996 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4997 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4998 else
4999 sb_width = width;
5000
5001 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5002 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5003 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5004 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5005 else
5006 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5007 #else
5008 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5009 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5010 else
5011 sb_left = left;
5012 #endif
5013
5014 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5015 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5016 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5017 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5018 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5019 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5020 else
5021 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5022 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5023 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5024 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5025 #endif
5026
5027 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5028 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5029 {
5030 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5031 {
5032 BLOCK_INPUT;
5033 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5034 if (fringe_extended_p)
5035 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5036 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5037 else
5038 #endif
5039 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5040 left, top, width, height, False);
5041 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5042 }
5043
5044 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5045 }
5046 else
5047 {
5048 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5049 unsigned int mask = 0;
5050
5051 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5052
5053 BLOCK_INPUT;
5054
5055 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5056 mask |= CWX;
5057 if (top != bar->top)
5058 mask |= CWY;
5059 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5060 mask |= CWWidth;
5061 if (height != bar->height)
5062 mask |= CWHeight;
5063
5064 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5065
5066 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5067 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5068 {
5069 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5070 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5071 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5072 {
5073 if (fringe_extended_p)
5074 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5075 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5076 else
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5079 }
5080 #ifdef USE_GTK
5081 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5082 bar->x_window,
5083 top,
5084 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5085 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5086 max (height, 1));
5087 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5088 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5089 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5090 top,
5091 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5092 max (height, 1), 0);
5093 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5094 }
5095 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096
5097 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5098 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5099 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5100 {
5101 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5102 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5103 height, False);
5104 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5105 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5106 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5107 height, False);
5108 }
5109
5110 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5111 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5112 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5113 example. */
5114 {
5115 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5116 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5117 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5118 {
5119 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5120 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5121 left + area_width - rest, top,
5122 rest, height, False);
5123 else
5124 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5125 left, top, rest, height, False);
5126 }
5127 }
5128
5129 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5130 if (mask)
5131 {
5132 XWindowChanges wc;
5133
5134 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5135 wc.y = top;
5136 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5137 wc.height = height;
5138 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5139 mask, &wc);
5140 }
5141
5142 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5143
5144 /* Remember new settings. */
5145 bar->left = sb_left;
5146 bar->top = top;
5147 bar->width = sb_width;
5148 bar->height = height;
5149
5150 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5151 }
5152
5153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5154 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5155
5156 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5157 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5158 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5159 dragged. */
5160 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5161 {
5162 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5163
5164 if (whole == 0)
5165 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5166 else
5167 {
5168 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5169 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5170 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5171 }
5172 }
5173 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5174
5175 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5176 }
5177
5178
5179 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5180 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5181 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5182 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5183 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5184 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5185 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5186
5187 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5188 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5189 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5190
5191 static void
5192 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5193 {
5194 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5195 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5196 {
5197 Lisp_Object bar;
5198 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5199 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5200 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5201 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5202 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5203 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5204 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5205 }
5206 }
5207
5208
5209 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5210 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5211
5212 static void
5213 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5214 {
5215 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5216 struct frame *f;
5217
5218 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5219 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5220 abort ();
5221
5222 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5223
5224 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5225 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5226 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5227 {
5228 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5229 the lists. */
5230 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5231 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5232 return;
5233 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5234 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5236 else
5237 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5238 one or the other! */
5239 abort ();
5240 }
5241 else
5242 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5243
5244 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5245 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5246
5247 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5248 bar->prev = Qnil;
5249 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5250 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5251 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5252 }
5253
5254 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5255 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5256
5257 static void
5258 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5259 {
5260 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5261
5262 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5263
5264 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5265 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5266 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5267
5268 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5269 {
5270 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5271
5272 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5273
5274 next = b->next;
5275 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5276 }
5277
5278 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5279 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5280 }
5281
5282
5283 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5284 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5285 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5286
5287 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5288 mark bits. */
5289
5290 static void
5291 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5292 {
5293 Window w = bar->x_window;
5294 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5295 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5296 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5297
5298 BLOCK_INPUT;
5299
5300 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5301
5302 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5303 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5304 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5305 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5306
5307 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5308 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5309
5310 /* x, y, width, height */
5311 0, 0,
5312 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5313 bar->height - 1);
5314
5315 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5316 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5317 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5318 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5319
5320 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5321
5322 }
5323 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5324
5325 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5326 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5327
5328 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5329 mark bits. */
5330
5331
5332 static void
5333 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5334 {
5335 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5336 abort ();
5337
5338 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5339 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5340 emacs_event->modifiers
5341 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5342 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5343 event->xbutton.state)
5344 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5345 ? up_modifier
5346 : down_modifier));
5347 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5348 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5349 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5350 {
5351 int top_range
5352 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5353 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5354
5355 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5356 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5357
5358 if (y < bar->start)
5359 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5360 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5361 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5362 else
5363 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5364
5365 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5366 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5367 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5368 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5369 {
5370 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5371 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5372
5373 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5375 }
5376 #endif
5377
5378 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5379 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5380 }
5381 }
5382
5383 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5384
5385 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5386
5387 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5388 mark bits. */
5389
5390 static void
5391 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5392 {
5393 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5394
5395 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5396
5397 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5398 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5399
5400 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5401 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5402 {
5403 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5404 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5405
5406 if (new_start != bar->start)
5407 {
5408 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5409
5410 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5411 }
5412 }
5413 }
5414
5415 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5416
5417 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5418 on the scroll bar. */
5419
5420 static void
5421 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5422 {
5423 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5424 Window w = bar->x_window;
5425 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5426 int win_x, win_y;
5427 Window dummy_window;
5428 int dummy_coord;
5429 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5430
5431 BLOCK_INPUT;
5432
5433 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5434 report that. */
5435 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5436
5437 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5438 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5439 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5440
5441 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5442 &win_x, &win_y,
5443
5444 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5445 &dummy_mask))
5446 ;
5447 else
5448 {
5449 int top_range
5450 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5451
5452 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5453
5454 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5455 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5456
5457 if (win_y < 0)
5458 win_y = 0;
5459 if (win_y > top_range)
5460 win_y = top_range;
5461
5462 *fp = f;
5463 *bar_window = bar->window;
5464
5465 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5466 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5467 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5468 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5469 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5470 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5471 else
5472 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5473
5474 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5475 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5476
5477 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5478 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5479 }
5480
5481 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5482
5483 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5484 }
5485
5486
5487 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5488 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5489 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5490 redraw them. */
5491
5492 void
5493 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5494 {
5495 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5496 Lisp_Object bar;
5497
5498 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5499 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5500 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5501 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5502 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5503 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5504 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5505 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5506 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5507 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5508 }
5509
5510 \f
5511 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5512
5513 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5514 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5515 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5516 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5517
5518 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5519 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5520
5521 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5522
5523 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5524 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5525
5526 static int temp_index;
5527 static short temp_buffer[100];
5528
5529 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5530 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5531 temp_index = 0; \
5532 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5533
5534 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5535 on a particular display. */
5536
5537 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5538
5539 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5540 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5541 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5542 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5543
5544 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5545
5546 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5547 do \
5548 { \
5549 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5550 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5551 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5552 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5553 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5554 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5555 } \
5556 while (0)
5557
5558 enum
5559 {
5560 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5561 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5562 X_EVENT_DROP
5563 };
5564
5565 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5566 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5567 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5568
5569 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5570 this event further.
5571 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5572
5573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5574 static int
5575 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5576 {
5577 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5578 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5579 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5580 was created. */
5581
5582 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5583 event->xclient.window);
5584
5585 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5586 }
5587 #endif
5588
5589 #ifdef USE_GTK
5590 static int current_count;
5591 static int current_finish;
5592 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5593
5594 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5595 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5596 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5597 static GdkFilterReturn
5598 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5599 {
5600 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5601
5602 BLOCK_INPUT;
5603 if (current_count >= 0)
5604 {
5605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5606
5607 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5608
5609 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5610 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5611 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5612 so we do it here. */
5613 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5614 && dpyinfo
5615 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5616 {
5617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5618 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5619 }
5620 #endif
5621
5622 if (! dpyinfo)
5623 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5624 else
5625 current_count +=
5626 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5627 current_hold_quit);
5628 }
5629 else
5630 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5631
5632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5633
5634 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5635 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5636
5637 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5638 }
5639 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5640
5641
5642 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5643
5644 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5645 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5646 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5647
5648 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5649
5650 static int
5651 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5652 {
5653 union {
5654 struct input_event ie;
5655 struct selection_input_event sie;
5656 } inev;
5657 int count = 0;
5658 int do_help = 0;
5659 int nbytes = 0;
5660 struct frame *f = NULL;
5661 struct coding_system coding;
5662 XEvent event = *eventp;
5663
5664 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5665
5666 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5667 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5668 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5669
5670 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5671 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5672
5673 switch (event.type)
5674 {
5675 case ClientMessage:
5676 {
5677 if (event.xclient.message_type
5678 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5679 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5680 {
5681 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5682 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5683 {
5684 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5685 could be the shell widget window
5686 if the frame has no title bar. */
5687 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5688 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5689 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5690 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5691 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5692 #endif
5693 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5694 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5695 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5696 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5697 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5698 needed.
5699
5700 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5701 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5702 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5703 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5704 Emacs. */
5705
5706 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5707 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5708 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5709 if (f)
5710 {
5711 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5712 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5713 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5714 x_catch_errors (d);
5715 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5716 /* The ICCCM says this is
5717 the only valid choice. */
5718 RevertToParent,
5719 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5720 /* This is needed to detect the error
5721 if there is an error. */
5722 XSync (d, False);
5723 x_uncatch_errors ();
5724 }
5725 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5726 #endif /* 0 */
5727 goto done;
5728 }
5729
5730 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5731 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5732 {
5733 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5734 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5735 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5736 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5737 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5738 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5739 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5740 session manager and one for this. */
5741 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5742 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5743 #endif
5744 {
5745 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5746 event.xclient.window);
5747 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5748 for a single Emacs process. */
5749 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5750 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5751 event.xclient.window,
5752 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5753 else if (f)
5754 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5755 event.xclient.window,
5756 0, 0);
5757 }
5758 goto done;
5759 }
5760
5761 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5762 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5763 {
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5765 event.xclient.window);
5766 if (!f)
5767 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5768
5769 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5771 goto done;
5772 }
5773
5774 goto done;
5775 }
5776
5777 if (event.xclient.message_type
5778 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5779 {
5780 goto done;
5781 }
5782
5783 if (event.xclient.message_type
5784 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5785 {
5786 int new_x, new_y;
5787 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5788
5789 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5790 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5791
5792 if (f)
5793 {
5794 f->left_pos = new_x;
5795 f->top_pos = new_y;
5796 }
5797 goto done;
5798 }
5799
5800 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5801 if (event.xclient.message_type
5802 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5803 {
5804 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5805 if (f)
5806 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5807 &event, NULL);
5808 goto done;
5809 }
5810 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5811
5812 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5813 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5814 || (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5816 {
5817 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5818 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5819 currently never do because we are interested in
5820 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5821 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5822 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5823 if (!f)
5824 goto OTHER;
5825 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5826 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5827 goto done;
5828 }
5829
5830 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5831 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5832 we construct an input_event. */
5833 if (event.xclient.message_type
5834 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5835 {
5836 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5837 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5838 goto done;
5839 }
5840 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5841
5842 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5843 if (event.xclient.message_type
5844 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5845 {
5846 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5847 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5848 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5849
5850 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5851 goto done;
5852 }
5853
5854 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5855
5856 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5857 if (!f)
5858 goto OTHER;
5859 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5860 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5861 }
5862 break;
5863
5864 case SelectionNotify:
5865 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5866 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5867 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5868 goto OTHER;
5869 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5870 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5871 break;
5872
5873 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5874 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5875 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5876 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5877 goto OTHER;
5878 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5879 {
5880 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5881
5882 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5883 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5886 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5887 }
5888 break;
5889
5890 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5891 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5892 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5893 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5894 goto OTHER;
5895 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5896 {
5897 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5898 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5899
5900 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5901 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5902 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5903 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5904 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5905 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5906 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5907 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5908 }
5909 break;
5910
5911 case PropertyNotify:
5912 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5913 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
5914 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
5915 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
5916
5917 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5918 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5919 goto OTHER;
5920
5921 case ReparentNotify:
5922 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5923 if (f)
5924 {
5925 int x, y;
5926 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5927 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5928 f->left_pos = x;
5929 f->top_pos = y;
5930
5931 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5932 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5933 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5934 }
5935 goto OTHER;
5936
5937 case Expose:
5938 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5939 if (f)
5940 {
5941 #ifdef USE_GTK
5942 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5943 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5944 event.xexpose.window,
5945 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5946 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5947 FALSE);
5948 #endif
5949 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5950 {
5951 f->async_visible = 1;
5952 f->async_iconified = 0;
5953 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5954 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5955 }
5956 else
5957 expose_frame (f,
5958 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5959 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5960 }
5961 else
5962 {
5963 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5964 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5965 #endif
5966 #if defined USE_LUCID
5967 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5968 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5969 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5970 {
5971 Widget widget
5972 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5973 if (widget)
5974 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5975 }
5976 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5977
5978 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5979 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5980 goto OTHER;
5981 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5982 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5983 event.xexpose.window);
5984
5985 if (bar)
5986 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5987 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5988 else
5989 goto OTHER;
5990 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5991 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5992 }
5993 break;
5994
5995 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5996 source area was obscured or not
5997 available. */
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5999 if (f)
6000 {
6001 expose_frame (f,
6002 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6003 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6004 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6005 }
6006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6007 else
6008 goto OTHER;
6009 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6010 break;
6011
6012 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6013 source area was completely
6014 available. */
6015 break;
6016
6017 case UnmapNotify:
6018 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6019 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6020 {
6021 tip_window = 0;
6022 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6023 }
6024
6025 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6026 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6027 the frame was deleted. */
6028 {
6029 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6030 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6031 display that won't ever be seen. */
6032 f->async_visible = 0;
6033 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6034 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6035 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6036 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6037 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6038 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6039 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6040 {
6041 f->async_iconified = 1;
6042
6043 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6044 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6045 }
6046 }
6047 goto OTHER;
6048
6049 case MapNotify:
6050 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6051 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6052 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6053 goto OTHER;
6054
6055 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6056 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6057 frame is visible. */
6058 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6059 if (f)
6060 {
6061 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6062 the frame's display structures.
6063 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6064 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6065 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6066 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6067 if (! f->async_iconified)
6068 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6069
6070 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6071 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6072 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6073 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6074
6075 f->async_visible = 1;
6076 f->async_iconified = 0;
6077 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6078
6079 if (f->iconified)
6080 {
6081 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6082 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6083 }
6084 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6085 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6086 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6087 to update the frame titles
6088 in case this is the second frame. */
6089 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6090
6091 #ifdef USE_GTK
6092 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6093 #endif
6094 }
6095 goto OTHER;
6096
6097 case KeyPress:
6098
6099 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6100 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6101
6102 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6103 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6104 if (popup_activated ())
6105 goto OTHER;
6106 #endif
6107
6108 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6109
6110 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6111 mouse highlighting. */
6112 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6113 && (f == 0
6114 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6115 {
6116 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6117 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6118 }
6119
6120 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6121 if (f == 0)
6122 {
6123 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6124 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6125 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6126 event.xkey.window);
6127 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6128 {
6129 widget = XtParent (widget);
6130 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6131 }
6132 }
6133 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6134
6135 if (f != 0)
6136 {
6137 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6138 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6139 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6140 his Emacs hang.
6141
6142 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6143 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6144 status_return even if the input is too long to
6145 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6146 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6147 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6148 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6149 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6150 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6151 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6152 int modifiers;
6153 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6154 Lisp_Object c;
6155
6156 #ifdef USE_GTK
6157 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6158 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6159 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6160 (see above). */
6161 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6162 #endif
6163
6164 event.xkey.state
6165 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6166 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6167 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6168
6169 /* This will have to go some day... */
6170
6171 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6172 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6173 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6174 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6175 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6176 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6177 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6178
6179 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6180 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6181 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6182 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6183 not it is combined with Meta. */
6184 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6185 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6186
6187 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6188 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6189 {
6190 Status status_return;
6191
6192 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6193 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6194 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6195 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6196 &status_return);
6197 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6198 {
6199 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6200 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6201 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6202 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6203 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6204 &status_return);
6205 }
6206 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6207 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6208 break;
6209 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6210 {
6211 keysym = NoSymbol;
6212 modifiers = 0;
6213 }
6214 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6215 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6216 abort ();
6217 }
6218 else
6219 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6220 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6221 &compose_status);
6222 #else
6223 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6224 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6225 &compose_status);
6226 #endif
6227
6228 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6229 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6230 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6231 break;
6232
6233 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6234 orig_keysym = keysym;
6235
6236 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6237 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6238 inev.ie.modifiers
6239 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6240 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6241
6242 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6243 translations to characters. */
6244 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6245 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6246 {
6247 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6248 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6249 goto done_keysym;
6250 }
6251
6252 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6253 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6254 {
6255 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6256 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6257 else
6258 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6259 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6260 goto done_keysym;
6261 }
6262
6263 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6264 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6265 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6266 Vx_keysym_table,
6267 Qnil))))
6268 {
6269 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6270 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6271 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6272 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6273 goto done_keysym;
6274 }
6275
6276 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6277 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6278 || keysym == XK_Delete
6279 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6280 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6281 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6282 #endif
6283 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6284 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6285 #ifdef HPUX
6286 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6287 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6288 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6289 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6290 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6291 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6292 #endif
6293 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6294 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6295 #endif
6296 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6297 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6298 #endif
6299 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6300 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6301 #endif
6302 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6303 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6304 #endif
6305 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6306 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6307 #endif
6308 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6309 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6310 #endif
6311 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6312 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6313 #endif
6314 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6315 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6316 #endif
6317 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6318 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6319 #endif
6320 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6321 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6322 #endif
6323 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6324 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6325 #endif
6326 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6327 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6328 #endif
6329 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6330 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6331 #endif
6332 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6333 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6334 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6335 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6336 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6337 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6338 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6339 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6340 don't have real modifiers but
6341 should be treated similarly to
6342 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6343 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6344 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6345 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6346 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6347 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6348 #endif
6349 ))
6350 {
6351 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6352 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6353 key. */
6354 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6355 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6356 goto done_keysym;
6357 }
6358
6359 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6360 register int i;
6361 register int c;
6362 int nchars, len;
6363
6364 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6365 {
6366 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6367 nchars++;
6368 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6369 }
6370
6371 if (nchars < nbytes)
6372 {
6373 /* Decode the input data. */
6374 int require;
6375 unsigned char *p;
6376
6377 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6378 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6379 we used just above and the locale. */
6380 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6381 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6382 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6383 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6384 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6385 gives us composition information. */
6386 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6387
6388 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6389 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6390 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6391 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6392 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6393 nbytes = coding.produced;
6394 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6395 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6396 }
6397
6398 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6399 character events. */
6400 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6401 {
6402 if (nchars == nbytes)
6403 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6404 else
6405 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6406 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6407 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6408 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6409 inev.ie.code = c;
6410 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6411 }
6412
6413 count += nchars;
6414
6415 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6416
6417 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6418 break;
6419 }
6420 }
6421 done_keysym:
6422 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6423 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6424 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6425 client. */
6426 break;
6427 #else
6428 goto OTHER;
6429 #endif
6430
6431 case KeyRelease:
6432 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6433 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6434 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6435 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6436 client. */
6437 break;
6438 #else
6439 goto OTHER;
6440 #endif
6441
6442 case EnterNotify:
6443 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6444 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6445
6446 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6447
6448 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6449 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6450
6451 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6452 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6453 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6454 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6455 #ifdef USE_GTK
6456 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6457 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6458 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6459 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6460 #endif
6461 goto OTHER;
6462
6463 case FocusIn:
6464 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6465 goto OTHER;
6466
6467 case LeaveNotify:
6468 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6469 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6470
6471 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6472 if (f)
6473 {
6474 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6475 {
6476 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6477 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6478 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6479 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6480 }
6481
6482 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6483 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6484 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6485 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6486 if (any_help_event_p)
6487 do_help = -1;
6488 }
6489 #ifdef USE_GTK
6490 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6491 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6492 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6493 #endif
6494 goto OTHER;
6495
6496 case FocusOut:
6497 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6498 goto OTHER;
6499
6500 case MotionNotify:
6501 {
6502 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6503 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6504 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6505
6506 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6507 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6508 f = last_mouse_frame;
6509 else
6510 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6511
6512 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6513 {
6514 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6515 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6516 }
6517
6518 #ifdef USE_GTK
6519 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6520 f = 0;
6521 #endif
6522 if (f)
6523 {
6524
6525 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6526 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6527 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6528 {
6529 Lisp_Object window;
6530
6531 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6532 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6533 0, 0, 0, 0);
6534
6535 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6536 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6537 will be selected only when it is active. */
6538 if (WINDOWP (window)
6539 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6540 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6541 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6542 create event iff we don't leave the
6543 selected frame. */
6544 && (focus_follows_mouse
6545 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6546 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6547 {
6548 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6549 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6550 }
6551
6552 last_window=window;
6553 }
6554 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6555 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6556 }
6557 else
6558 {
6559 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6560 struct scroll_bar *bar
6561 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6562 event.xmotion.window);
6563
6564 if (bar)
6565 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6566 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6567
6568 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6569 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6570 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6571 }
6572
6573 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6574 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6575 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6576 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6577 do_help = 1;
6578 goto OTHER;
6579 }
6580
6581 case ConfigureNotify:
6582 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6583 #ifdef USE_GTK
6584 if (!f
6585 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6586 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6587 {
6588 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6589 event.xconfigure.height);
6590 f = 0;
6591 }
6592 #endif
6593 if (f)
6594 {
6595 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6596 #ifndef USE_GTK
6597 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6598 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6599
6600 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6601 is called by the code that handles resizing
6602 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6603
6604 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6605 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6606 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6607 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6608 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6609 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6610 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6611 {
6612 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6613 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6614 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6615 }
6616
6617 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6618 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6619 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6620 #endif
6621
6622 #ifdef USE_GTK
6623 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6624 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6625 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6626 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6627 #endif
6628 {
6629 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6630 }
6631
6632 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6633 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6634 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6635 #endif
6636
6637 }
6638 goto OTHER;
6639
6640 case ButtonRelease:
6641 case ButtonPress:
6642 {
6643 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6644 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6645 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6646
6647 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6648 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6649 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6650
6651 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6652 && last_mouse_frame
6653 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6654 f = last_mouse_frame;
6655 else
6656 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6657
6658 #ifdef USE_GTK
6659 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6660 f = 0;
6661 #endif
6662 if (f)
6663 {
6664 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6665 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6666 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6667 {
6668 Lisp_Object window;
6669 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6670 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6671
6672 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6673 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6674
6675 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6676 {
6677 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6678 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6679 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6680 event.xbutton.state));
6681 }
6682 }
6683
6684 if (!tool_bar_p)
6685 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6686 if (! popup_activated ())
6687 #endif
6688 {
6689 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6690 {
6691 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6692 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6693 {
6694 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6695 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6696 }
6697 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6698 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6699 }
6700 else
6701 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6702 }
6703 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6704 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6705 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6706 }
6707 else
6708 {
6709 struct scroll_bar *bar
6710 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6711 event.xbutton.window);
6712
6713 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6714 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6715 scroll bars. */
6716 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6717 {
6718 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6719 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6720 }
6721 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6722 if (bar)
6723 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6724 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6725 }
6726
6727 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6728 {
6729 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6730 last_mouse_frame = f;
6731
6732 if (!tool_bar_p)
6733 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6734 }
6735 else
6736 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6737
6738 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6739 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6740 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6741 if (f != 0)
6742 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6743
6744 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6745 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6746 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6747 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6748 Instead, save it away
6749 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6750 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6751 if (! popup_activated ()
6752 #ifdef USE_GTK
6753 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6754 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6755 #endif
6756 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6757 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6758 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6759 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6760 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6761 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6762 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6763 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6764 {
6765 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6766 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6767 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6768 }
6769 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6770 {
6771 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6772 goto OTHER;
6773 }
6774 else
6775 goto OTHER;
6776 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6777 }
6778 break;
6779
6780 case CirculateNotify:
6781 goto OTHER;
6782
6783 case CirculateRequest:
6784 goto OTHER;
6785
6786 case VisibilityNotify:
6787 goto OTHER;
6788
6789 case MappingNotify:
6790 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6791 local cache. */
6792 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6793 {
6794 case MappingModifier:
6795 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6796 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6797 case MappingKeyboard:
6798 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6799 }
6800 goto OTHER;
6801
6802 case DestroyNotify:
6803 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6804 break;
6805
6806 default:
6807 OTHER:
6808 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6809 BLOCK_INPUT;
6810 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6811 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6813 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6814 break;
6815 }
6816
6817 done:
6818 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6819 {
6820 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6821 count++;
6822 }
6823
6824 if (do_help
6825 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6826 {
6827 Lisp_Object frame;
6828
6829 if (f)
6830 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6831 else
6832 frame = Qnil;
6833
6834 if (do_help > 0)
6835 {
6836 any_help_event_p = 1;
6837 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6838 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6839 }
6840 else
6841 {
6842 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6843 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6844 }
6845 count++;
6846 }
6847
6848 *eventp = event;
6849 return count;
6850 }
6851
6852
6853 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6854 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6855 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6856
6857 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6858 int
6859 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6860 {
6861 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6862 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6863
6864 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6865
6866 if (dpyinfo)
6867 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6868
6869 return finish;
6870 }
6871
6872
6873 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6874 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6875 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6876
6877 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6878 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
6879 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
6880 C chars).
6881
6882 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6883
6884 static int
6885 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
6886 {
6887 int count = 0;
6888 XEvent event;
6889 int event_found = 0;
6890
6891 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6892 {
6893 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6894 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6895 pending_signals = 1;
6896 #endif
6897 return -1;
6898 }
6899
6900 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6901 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6902 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
6903 #endif
6904 BLOCK_INPUT;
6905
6906 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6907 input_signal_count++;
6908
6909 ++handling_signal;
6910
6911 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6912 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
6913 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
6914 {
6915 struct input_event inev;
6916 BLOCK_INPUT;
6917 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
6918 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
6919 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
6920 {
6921 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6922 count++;
6923 }
6924 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6925 }
6926 #endif
6927
6928 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6929 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6930 {
6931 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
6932 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
6933 }
6934
6935 #ifndef USE_GTK
6936 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
6937 {
6938 int finish;
6939
6940 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
6941
6942 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6943 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
6944 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
6945 continue;
6946 #endif
6947 event_found = 1;
6948
6949 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
6950 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
6951
6952 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
6953 goto out;
6954 }
6955
6956 #else /* USE_GTK */
6957
6958 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
6959 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
6960 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
6961 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
6962
6963 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
6964 from all displays. */
6965
6966 while (gtk_events_pending ())
6967 {
6968 current_count = count;
6969 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
6970
6971 gtk_main_iteration ();
6972
6973 count = current_count;
6974 current_count = -1;
6975 current_hold_quit = 0;
6976
6977 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
6978 break;
6979 }
6980 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6981
6982 out:;
6983
6984 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
6985 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
6986 if (! event_found)
6987 {
6988 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
6989 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
6990 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
6991 x_noop_count++;
6992 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
6993 {
6994 x_noop_count=0;
6995
6996 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
6997 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
6998
6999 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7000
7001 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7002 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7003 }
7004 }
7005
7006 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7007 raise it now. */
7008 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7009 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7010 {
7011 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7012 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7013 }
7014
7015 --handling_signal;
7016 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7017
7018 return count;
7019 }
7020
7021
7022
7023 \f
7024 /***********************************************************************
7025 Text Cursor
7026 ***********************************************************************/
7027
7028 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7029 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7030
7031 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7032 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7033 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7034
7035 static void
7036 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7037 {
7038 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7039 XRectangle clip_rect;
7040 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7041
7042 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7043
7044 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7045 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7046 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7047 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7048 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7049
7050 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7051 }
7052
7053
7054 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7055
7056 static void
7057 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7058 {
7059 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7060 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7061 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7062 int x, y, wd, h;
7063 XGCValues xgcv;
7064 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7065 GC gc;
7066
7067 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7068 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7069 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7070 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7071 return;
7072
7073 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7074 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7075 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7076
7077 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7078 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7079 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7080 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7081 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7082 else
7083 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7084 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7085 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7086
7087 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7088 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7089 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7090 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7091 }
7092
7093
7094 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7095
7096 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7097 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7098 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7099 --gerd. */
7100
7101 static void
7102 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7103 {
7104 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7105 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7106
7107 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7108 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7109 and mini-buffer. */
7110 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7111 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7112 return;
7113
7114 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7115 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7116 the bar might not be in the window. */
7117 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7118 {
7119 struct glyph_row *row;
7120 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7121 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7122 }
7123 else
7124 {
7125 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7126 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7127 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7128 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7129 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7130 XGCValues xgcv;
7131
7132 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7133 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7134 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7135 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7136 that the glyph is legible. */
7137 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7138 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7139 else
7140 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7141 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7142
7143 if (gc)
7144 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7145 else
7146 {
7147 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7148 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7149 }
7150
7151 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7152
7153 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7154 {
7155 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7156
7157 if (width < 0)
7158 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7159 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7160
7161 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7162
7163 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7164 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7165 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7166 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7167
7168 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7169 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7170 width, row->height);
7171 }
7172 else
7173 {
7174 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7175
7176 if (width < 0)
7177 width = row->height;
7178
7179 width = min (row->height, width);
7180
7181 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7182 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7183
7184 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7185 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7186 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7187 row->height - width),
7188 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7189 }
7190
7191 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7192 }
7193 }
7194
7195
7196 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7197
7198 static void
7199 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7200 {
7201 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7202 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7203 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7204 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7205 }
7206
7207
7208 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7209
7210 static void
7211 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7212 {
7213 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7214 x, y, width, height, False);
7215 #ifdef USE_GTK
7216 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7217 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7218 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7219 #endif
7220 }
7221
7222
7223 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7224
7225 static void
7226 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7227 {
7228 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7229
7230 if (on_p)
7231 {
7232 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7233 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7234
7235 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7236 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7237 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7238 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7239 {
7240 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7241 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7242 }
7243 else
7244 {
7245 switch (cursor_type)
7246 {
7247 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7248 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7249 break;
7250
7251 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7252 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7253 break;
7254
7255 case BAR_CURSOR:
7256 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7257 break;
7258
7259 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7260 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7261 break;
7262
7263 case NO_CURSOR:
7264 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7265 break;
7266
7267 default:
7268 abort ();
7269 }
7270 }
7271
7272 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7273 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7274 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7275 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7276 #endif
7277 }
7278
7279 #ifndef XFlush
7280 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7281 #endif
7282 }
7283
7284 \f
7285 /* Icons. */
7286
7287 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7288
7289 int
7290 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7291 {
7292 int bitmap_id;
7293
7294 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7295 return 1;
7296
7297 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7298 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7299 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7300 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7301
7302 if (STRINGP (file))
7303 {
7304 #ifdef USE_GTK
7305 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7306 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7307 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7308 return 0;
7309 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7310 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7311 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7312 }
7313 else
7314 {
7315 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7316 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7317 {
7318 int rc = -1;
7319
7320 #ifdef USE_GTK
7321
7322 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7323 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7324 return 0;
7325
7326 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7327
7328 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7329 if (rc != -1)
7330 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7331
7332 #endif
7333
7334 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7335 if (rc == -1)
7336 {
7337 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7338 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7339 if (rc == -1)
7340 return 1;
7341
7342 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7343 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7344 }
7345 }
7346
7347 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7348 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7349 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7350 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7351 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7352
7353 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7354 }
7355
7356 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7357 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7358
7359 return 0;
7360 }
7361
7362
7363 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7364 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7365
7366 int
7367 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7368 {
7369 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7370 return 1;
7371
7372 {
7373 XTextProperty text;
7374 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7375 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7376 text.format = 8;
7377 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7378 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7379 }
7380
7381 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7382 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7383 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7384 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7385
7386 return 0;
7387 }
7388 \f
7389 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7390
7391 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7392 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7393
7394 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7395 be called from a signal handler.
7396 */
7397
7398 struct x_error_message_stack {
7399 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7400 Display *dpy;
7401 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7402 };
7403 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7404
7405 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7406 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7407 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7408
7409 static void
7410 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7411 {
7412 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7413 x_error_message->string,
7414 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7415 }
7416
7417 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7418 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7419 operating on.
7420
7421 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7422 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7423 stored in *x_error_message.
7424
7425 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7426 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7427
7428 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7429
7430 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7431
7432 void
7433 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7434 {
7435 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7436
7437 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7438 XSync (dpy, False);
7439
7440 data->dpy = dpy;
7441 data->string[0] = 0;
7442 data->prev = x_error_message;
7443 x_error_message = data;
7444 }
7445
7446 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7447 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7448
7449 void
7450 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7451 {
7452 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7453
7454 BLOCK_INPUT;
7455
7456 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7457 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7458 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7459 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7460
7461 tmp = x_error_message;
7462 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7463 xfree (tmp);
7464 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7465 }
7466
7467 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7468 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7469 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7470
7471 void
7472 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7473 {
7474 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7475 XSync (dpy, False);
7476
7477 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7478 {
7479 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7480 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7481 x_uncatch_errors ();
7482 error (format, string);
7483 }
7484 }
7485
7486 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7487 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7488
7489 int
7490 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7491 {
7492 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7493 XSync (dpy, False);
7494
7495 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7496 }
7497
7498 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7499
7500 void
7501 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7502 {
7503 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7504 }
7505
7506 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7507 * idea. --lorentey */
7508 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7509
7510 void
7511 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7512 {
7513 while (x_error_message)
7514 x_uncatch_errors ();
7515 }
7516 #endif
7517
7518 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7519
7520 int
7521 x_catching_errors (void)
7522 {
7523 return x_error_message != 0;
7524 }
7525
7526 #if 0
7527 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7528 x_trace_wire (void)
7529 {
7530 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7531 }
7532 #endif /* ! 0 */
7533
7534 \f
7535 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7536 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7537 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7538 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7539 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7540
7541 static SIGTYPE
7542 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7543 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7544 {
7545 #ifdef USG
7546 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7547 must reestablish each time */
7548 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7549 #endif /* USG */
7550 }
7551
7552 \f
7553 /************************************************************************
7554 Handling X errors
7555 ************************************************************************/
7556
7557 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7558
7559 static char *error_msg;
7560
7561 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7562 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7563 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7564
7565 static void
7566 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7567 {
7568 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7569 exit (70);
7570 }
7571
7572 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7573 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7574
7575 static SIGTYPE
7576 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7577 {
7578 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7579 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7580 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7581
7582 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7583 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7584 handling_signal = 0;
7585
7586 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7587 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7588 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7589 the original message here. */
7590 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7591
7592 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7593 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7594
7595 if (dpyinfo)
7596 {
7597 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7598 frame on it. */
7599 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7600 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7601 }
7602
7603 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7604 that are on the dead display. */
7605 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7606 {
7607 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7608 minibuf_frame
7609 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7610 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7611 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7612 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7613 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7614 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7615 }
7616
7617 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7618 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7619 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7620 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7621 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7622 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7623 {
7624 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7625 trying to find a replacement. */
7626 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7627 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7628 }
7629
7630 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7631 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7632 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7633
7634 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7635 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7636 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7637
7638 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7639 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7640
7641 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7642 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7643 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7644
7645 if (dpyinfo)
7646 {
7647 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7648 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7649 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7650 {
7651 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7652 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7653 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7654 }
7655 #endif
7656
7657 #ifdef USE_GTK
7658 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
7659 is the last display/terminal. */
7660 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
7661 {
7662 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7663 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7664 /* NOTREACHED */
7665 }
7666 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7667 #endif
7668
7669 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7670 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7671
7672 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7673 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7674 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7675 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7676 abort ();
7677
7678 {
7679 Lisp_Object tmp;
7680 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7681 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7682 }
7683 }
7684
7685 x_uncatch_errors ();
7686
7687 if (terminal_list == 0)
7688 {
7689 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7690 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7691 /* NOTREACHED */
7692 }
7693
7694 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7695 #ifdef SIGIO
7696 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7697 #endif
7698 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7699 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7700
7701 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7702 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7703 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7704 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7705 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7706 error ("%s", error_msg);
7707 }
7708
7709 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7710 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7711 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7712
7713 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7714 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7715
7716 static int
7717 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7718 {
7719 if (x_error_message)
7720 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7721 else
7722 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7723 return 0;
7724 }
7725
7726 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7727 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7728 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7729
7730 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7731
7732 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7733 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7734 #else
7735 #define NO_INLINE
7736 #endif
7737
7738 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7739
7740 #ifdef noinline
7741 #undef noinline
7742 #endif
7743
7744 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7745 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7746
7747 static void NO_INLINE
7748 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7749 {
7750 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7751
7752 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7753 or colors that are not defined. */
7754
7755 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7756 return;
7757
7758 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7759 original error handler. */
7760
7761 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7762 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7763 buf, error->request_code);
7764 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7765 }
7766
7767
7768 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7769 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7770 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7771
7772 static int
7773 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7774 {
7775 char buf[256];
7776
7777 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7778 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7779 return 0;
7780 }
7781 \f
7782 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7783
7784 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7785 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7786 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7787 FONT-OBJECT. */
7788
7789 Lisp_Object
7790 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7791 {
7792 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7793
7794 if (fontset < 0)
7795 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7796 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7797 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7798 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7799 do. */
7800 return font_object;
7801
7802 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7803 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7804 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7805 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7806 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7807
7808 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7809
7810 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7811 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7812 {
7813 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7814 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7815 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7816 }
7817 else
7818 {
7819 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7820 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7821 }
7822
7823 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7824 {
7825 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7826 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7827 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7828 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7829 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7830 }
7831
7832 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7833 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7834 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7835 {
7836 BLOCK_INPUT;
7837 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7838 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7839 }
7840 #endif
7841
7842 return font_object;
7843 }
7844
7845 \f
7846 /***********************************************************************
7847 X Input Methods
7848 ***********************************************************************/
7849
7850 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7851
7852 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7853
7854 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7855 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7856 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7857
7858 static void
7859 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7860 {
7861 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7862 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7863
7864 BLOCK_INPUT;
7865
7866 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7867 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7868 {
7869 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7870 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7871 {
7872 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7873 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7874 }
7875 }
7876
7877 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7878 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7879 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7880 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7881 }
7882
7883 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7884
7885 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7886 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7887 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7888 #endif
7889
7890 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7891 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7892
7893 static void
7894 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7895 {
7896 XIM xim;
7897
7898 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7899 if (use_xim)
7900 {
7901 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7902 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7903 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7904 emacs_class);
7905 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7906
7907 if (xim)
7908 {
7909 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7910 XIMCallback destroy;
7911 #endif
7912
7913 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7914 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7915
7916 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7917 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7918 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7919 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7920 #endif
7921 }
7922 }
7923
7924 else
7925 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7926 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7927 }
7928
7929
7930 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7931
7932 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7933 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7934 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7935 when the callback was registered. */
7936
7937 static void
7938 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7939 {
7940 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
7941 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
7942
7943 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
7944 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7945 return;
7946
7947 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
7948
7949 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
7950 as they have no XIC. */
7951 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
7952 {
7953 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
7954
7955 BLOCK_INPUT;
7956 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7957 {
7958 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7959
7960 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
7961 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
7962 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
7963 {
7964 create_frame_xic (f);
7965 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
7966 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7967 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
7968 {
7969 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
7970 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
7971 }
7972 }
7973 }
7974
7975 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7976 }
7977 }
7978
7979 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
7980
7981
7982 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7983 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
7984 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
7985 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
7986
7987 static void
7988 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7989 {
7990 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7991 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7992 if (use_xim)
7993 {
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7995 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
7996 int len;
7997
7998 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
7999 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8000 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8001 len = strlen (resource_name);
8002 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8003 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8004 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8005 resource_name, emacs_class,
8006 xim_instantiate_callback,
8007 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8008 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8009 least, hence the configure test. */
8010 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8011 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8012 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8013 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8014 }
8015 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8016 }
8017
8018
8019 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8020
8021 static void
8022 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8023 {
8024 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8025 if (use_xim)
8026 {
8027 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8028 if (dpyinfo->display)
8029 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8030 NULL, emacs_class,
8031 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8032 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8033 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8034 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8035 if (dpyinfo->display)
8036 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8037 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8038 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8039 }
8040 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8041 }
8042
8043 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8044
8045
8046 \f
8047 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8048 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8049
8050 void
8051 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8052 {
8053 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8054
8055 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8056 is already for the top-left corner. */
8057 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8058 return;
8059
8060 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8061 position that fits on the screen. */
8062 if (flags & XNegative)
8063 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8064 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8065
8066 {
8067 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8068
8069 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8070 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8071 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8072
8073 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8074 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8075 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8076 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8077 is right, though.
8078
8079 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8080 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8081
8082 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8083 #endif
8084
8085 if (flags & YNegative)
8086 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8087 - height + f->top_pos;
8088 }
8089
8090 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8091 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8092 so the flags should correspond. */
8093 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8094 }
8095
8096 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8097 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8098 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8099 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8100 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8101
8102 void
8103 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8104 {
8105 int modified_top, modified_left;
8106
8107 if (change_gravity > 0)
8108 {
8109 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8110 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8111
8112 f->top_pos = yoff;
8113 f->left_pos = xoff;
8114 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8115 if (xoff < 0)
8116 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8117 if (yoff < 0)
8118 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8119 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8120 }
8121 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8122
8123 BLOCK_INPUT;
8124 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8125
8126 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8127 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8128
8129 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8130 {
8131 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8132 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8133 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8134 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8135 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8136 }
8137
8138 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8139 modified_left, modified_top);
8140
8141 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8142 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8143 ? 1 : 0);
8144
8145 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8146 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8147 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8148 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8149 of the frame.
8150
8151 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8152 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8153 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8154
8155 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8156 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8157 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8158 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8159 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8160 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8161
8162 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8163 }
8164
8165 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8166 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8167 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8168 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8169 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8170
8171 static int
8172 wm_supports (struct frame *f, const char *atomname)
8173 {
8174 Atom actual_type;
8175 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8176 int i, rc, actual_format;
8177 Atom prop_atom;
8178 Window wmcheck_window;
8179 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8180 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8181 long max_len = 65536;
8182 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8183 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8184 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8185 Atom want_atom;
8186
8187 BLOCK_INPUT;
8188
8189 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8190
8191 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8192 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8193 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8194 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8195 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8196
8197 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8198 {
8199 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8200 x_uncatch_errors ();
8201 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8202 return 0;
8203 }
8204
8205 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8206 XFree (tmp_data);
8207
8208 /* Check if window exists. */
8209 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8210 x_sync (f);
8211 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8212 {
8213 x_uncatch_errors ();
8214 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8215 return 0;
8216 }
8217
8218 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8219 {
8220 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8221 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8222 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8223 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8224 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8225 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8226
8227 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8228 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8229 tmp_data = NULL;
8230 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8231 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8232 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8233 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8234
8235 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8236 {
8237 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8238 x_uncatch_errors ();
8239 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8240 return 0;
8241 }
8242
8243 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8244 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8245 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8246 }
8247
8248 rc = 0;
8249 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8250
8251 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8252 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8253
8254 x_uncatch_errors ();
8255 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8256
8257 return rc;
8258 }
8259
8260 static void
8261 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, const char *what, const char *what2)
8262 {
8263 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8264 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8265 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8266 make_number (32),
8267 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8268 Fcons
8269 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8270 Fcons
8271 (make_unibyte_string (what, strlen (what)),
8272 what2 != 0
8273 ? Fcons (make_unibyte_string (what2, strlen (what2)),
8274 Qnil)
8275 : Qnil)));
8276 }
8277
8278 void
8279 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8280 {
8281 Lisp_Object frame;
8282
8283 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8284 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8285 "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", NULL);
8286 }
8287
8288 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8289
8290 static int
8291 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8292 {
8293 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8294
8295 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8296 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8297 if (!have_net_atom)
8298 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8299
8300 if (have_net_atom)
8301 {
8302 Lisp_Object frame;
8303 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8304 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8305 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8306
8307 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8308
8309 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, NULL);
8310 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fh, NULL);
8311 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fw, NULL);
8312
8313 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8314 hints. */
8315 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8316 {
8317 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8318 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fs, NULL);
8319 break;
8320 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8321 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, NULL);
8322 break;
8323 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8324 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fh, NULL);
8325 break;
8326 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8327 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, fh);
8328 break;
8329 }
8330
8331 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8332
8333 }
8334
8335 return have_net_atom;
8336 }
8337
8338 static void
8339 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8340 {
8341 if (f->async_visible)
8342 {
8343 BLOCK_INPUT;
8344 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8345 x_sync (f);
8346 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8347 }
8348 }
8349
8350
8351 static void
8352 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8353 {
8354 Atom actual_type;
8355 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8356 int i, rc, actual_format, value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8357 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8358 long max_len = 65536;
8359 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8360 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8361 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8362 Lisp_Object lval;
8363 int sticky = 0;
8364
8365 BLOCK_INPUT;
8366 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8367 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, event->window,
8368 event->atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8369 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8370 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8371
8372 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8373 {
8374 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8375 x_uncatch_errors ();
8376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8377 return;
8378 }
8379
8380 x_uncatch_errors ();
8381
8382 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8383 {
8384 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8385 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8386 {
8387 if (value == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8388 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8389 else
8390 value = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8391 }
8392 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8393 {
8394 if (value == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8395 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8396 else
8397 value = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8398 }
8399 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom)
8400 value = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8401 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8402 sticky = 1;
8403 }
8404
8405 lval = Qnil;
8406 switch (value)
8407 {
8408 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8409 lval = Qfullwidth;
8410 break;
8411 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8412 lval = Qfullheight;
8413 break;
8414 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8415 lval = Qfullboth;
8416 break;
8417 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8418 lval = Qmaximized;
8419 break;
8420 }
8421
8422 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8423 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8424
8425 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8426 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8427 }
8428
8429 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8430 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8431 static void
8432 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8433 {
8434 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8435 return;
8436
8437 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8438 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8439
8440 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8441 {
8442 int width = FRAME_COLS (f), height = FRAME_LINES (f);
8443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8444
8445 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8446 {
8447 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8448 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8449 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8450 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8451 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8452 break;
8453 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8454 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8455 break;
8456 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8457 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8458 }
8459
8460 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8461 {
8462 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8463 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8464 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8465 }
8466 }
8467 }
8468
8469 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8470 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8471 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8472 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8473 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8474 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8475 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8476
8477 static void
8478 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8479 {
8480 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8481
8482 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8483 window manager window around the frame. */
8484
8485 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8486
8487 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8488 {
8489 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8490
8491 int adjusted_left;
8492 int adjusted_top;
8493
8494 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8495 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8496 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8497
8498 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8499
8500 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8501 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8502
8503 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8504 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8505
8506 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8507 }
8508 else
8509 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8510 frame's position. */
8511
8512 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8513 }
8514
8515
8516 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8517 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8518 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8519 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8520 of an exact comparison. */
8521
8522 static void
8523 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8524 {
8525 int count = 0;
8526
8527 while (count++ < 50)
8528 {
8529 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8530
8531 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8532 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8533 loop. */
8534
8535 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8536 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8537
8538 if (fuzzy)
8539 {
8540 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8541 pixels. */
8542
8543 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8544 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8545 return;
8546 }
8547 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8548 return;
8549 }
8550
8551 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8552 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8553
8554 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8555 }
8556
8557
8558 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8559 void
8560 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8561 {
8562 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8563
8564 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8565 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8566 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8567
8568 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8569 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8570
8571 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8572 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8573 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8574 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8575 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8576
8577 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8578 {
8579 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8580 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8581 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8582 BLOCK_INPUT;
8583 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8584
8585 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8586 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8587
8588 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8589 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8590
8591 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8592 break; /* Timeout */
8593 }
8594 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8595 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8596 }
8597
8598
8599 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8600 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8601 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8602 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8603
8604 static void
8605 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8606 {
8607 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8608
8609 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8610 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8611 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8612 ? 0
8613 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8614
8615 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8616
8617 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8618 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8619 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8620 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8621
8622 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8623 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8624 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8625 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8626
8627
8628 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8629 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8630 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8631 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8632 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8633
8634 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8635 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8636 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8637 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8638
8639 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8640 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8641 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8642 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8643 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8644
8645 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8646 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8647
8648 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8649 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8650 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8651 if (f->async_visible)
8652 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8653 else
8654 {
8655 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8656 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8657 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8658 x_sync (f);
8659 }
8660 }
8661
8662
8663 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8664 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8665 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8666 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8667
8668 void
8669 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8670 {
8671 BLOCK_INPUT;
8672
8673 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8674 {
8675 int r, c;
8676
8677 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8678 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8679 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8680 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8681 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8682 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8683 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8684 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8685 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8686 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8687 is however. */
8688 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8689 #endif
8690 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8691 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8692 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8693 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8694 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8695 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8696 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8697 }
8698
8699 #ifdef USE_GTK
8700 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8701 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8702 else
8703 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8704 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8705
8706 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8707
8708 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8709
8710 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8711 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8712
8713 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8714 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8715 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8716 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8717 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8718
8719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8720 }
8721 \f
8722 /* Mouse warping. */
8723
8724 void
8725 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8726 {
8727 int pix_x, pix_y;
8728
8729 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8730 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8731
8732 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8733 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8734
8735 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8736 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8737
8738 BLOCK_INPUT;
8739
8740 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8741 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8742 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8743 }
8744
8745 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8746
8747 void
8748 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8749 {
8750 BLOCK_INPUT;
8751
8752 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8753 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8755 }
8756 \f
8757 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8758
8759 void
8760 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8761 {
8762 #if 0
8763 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8764 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8765 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8766 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8767 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8768 #endif /* ! 0 */
8769 }
8770
8771 void
8772 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8773 {
8774 #if 0
8775 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8776 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8777 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8778 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8779 #endif /* ! 0 */
8780 }
8781
8782 /* Raise frame F. */
8783
8784 void
8785 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8786 {
8787 BLOCK_INPUT;
8788 if (f->async_visible)
8789 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8790
8791 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8792 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8793 }
8794
8795 /* Lower frame F. */
8796
8797 void
8798 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8799 {
8800 if (f->async_visible)
8801 {
8802 BLOCK_INPUT;
8803 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8804 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8805 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8806 }
8807 }
8808
8809 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8810
8811 void
8812 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8813 {
8814 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8815 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8816
8817 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8818 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8819 {
8820 Lisp_Object frame;
8821 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8822 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8823 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8824 make_number (32),
8825 Fcons (make_number (1),
8826 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8827 Qnil)));
8828 }
8829 }
8830
8831 static void
8832 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8833 {
8834 if (raise_flag)
8835 x_raise_frame (f);
8836 else
8837 x_lower_frame (f);
8838 }
8839 \f
8840 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8841
8842 void
8843 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8844 {
8845 Atom atom;
8846 unsigned long data[2];
8847
8848 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
8849
8850 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8851 data[1] = flags;
8852
8853 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
8854 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8855 }
8856
8857 void
8858 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8859 {
8860 XEvent event;
8861
8862 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8863 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8864 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8865 event.xclient.format = 32;
8866 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
8867 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
8868 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8869 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8870 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8871
8872 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8873 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8874 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8875 }
8876 \f
8877 /* Change of visibility. */
8878
8879 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8880 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8881 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8882 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8883 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8884 finishes with it. */
8885
8886 void
8887 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8888 {
8889 Lisp_Object type;
8890 int original_top, original_left;
8891 int retry_count = 2;
8892
8893 retry:
8894
8895 BLOCK_INPUT;
8896
8897 type = x_icon_type (f);
8898 if (!NILP (type))
8899 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8900
8901 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8902 {
8903 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8904 call x_set_offset a second time
8905 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8906 before the window gets really visible. */
8907 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8908 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8909 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8910 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8911
8912 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8913
8914 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8915 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8916 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8917 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8918 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8919 else
8920 {
8921 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8922 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8923 }
8924 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8925 #ifdef USE_GTK
8926 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8927 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8928 #else
8929 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8930 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8931 else
8932 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8933 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8934 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8935 }
8936
8937 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8938
8939 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8940 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8941 so that incoming events are handled. */
8942 {
8943 Lisp_Object frame;
8944 int count;
8945 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8946 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8947 will set it when they are handled. */
8948 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8949
8950 original_left = f->left_pos;
8951 original_top = f->top_pos;
8952
8953 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8954 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8955
8956 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8957
8958 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8959 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8960 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8961 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8962
8963 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8964 because the window manager may choose the position
8965 and we don't want to override it. */
8966
8967 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8968 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8969 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8970 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8971 && previously_visible)
8972 {
8973 Drawable rootw;
8974 int x, y;
8975 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8976
8977 BLOCK_INPUT;
8978
8979 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8980 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8981 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8982 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8983 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8984 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8985 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8986 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8987 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8988
8989 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8990 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8991 original_left, original_top);
8992
8993 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8994 }
8995
8996 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8997
8998 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8999 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9000 MapNotify at all.. */
9001 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9002 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9003 {
9004 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9005 x_sync (f);
9006
9007 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9008 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9009 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9010 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9011 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9012 probably a bug. */
9013 if (input_polling_used ())
9014 {
9015 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9016 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9017 handler reset it. */
9018 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9019 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9020 poll_for_input_1 ();
9021 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9022 }
9023
9024 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9025 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9026 }
9027
9028 /* 2000-09-28: In
9029
9030 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9031 (iconify-frame f)
9032 (raise-frame f))
9033
9034 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9035 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9036 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9037 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9038
9039 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9040 goto retry;
9041 }
9042 }
9043
9044 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9045
9046 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9047
9048 void
9049 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9050 {
9051 Window window;
9052
9053 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9054 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9055
9056 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9057 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9058 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9059
9060 BLOCK_INPUT;
9061
9062 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9063 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9064 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9065 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9066 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9067 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9068
9069 #ifdef USE_GTK
9070 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9071 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9072 else
9073 #else
9074 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9075 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9076 else
9077 #endif
9078 {
9079
9080 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9081 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9082 {
9083 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9084 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9085 }
9086 }
9087
9088 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9089 just by the event that we get from the server.
9090 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9091 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9092 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9093 f->visible = 0;
9094 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9095 f->async_visible = 0;
9096 f->async_iconified = 0;
9097
9098 x_sync (f);
9099
9100 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9101 }
9102
9103 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9104
9105 void
9106 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9107 {
9108 int result;
9109 Lisp_Object type;
9110
9111 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9112 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9113 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9114
9115 if (f->async_iconified)
9116 return;
9117
9118 BLOCK_INPUT;
9119
9120 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9121
9122 type = x_icon_type (f);
9123 if (!NILP (type))
9124 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9125
9126 #ifdef USE_GTK
9127 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9128 {
9129 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9130 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9131
9132 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9133 f->iconified = 1;
9134 f->visible = 1;
9135 f->async_iconified = 1;
9136 f->async_visible = 0;
9137 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9138 return;
9139 }
9140 #endif
9141
9142 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9143
9144 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9145 {
9146 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9147 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9148 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9149 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9150 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9151 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9152 so we have to record it here. */
9153 f->iconified = 1;
9154 f->visible = 1;
9155 f->async_iconified = 1;
9156 f->async_visible = 0;
9157 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9158 return;
9159 }
9160
9161 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9162 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9163 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9164 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9165
9166 if (!result)
9167 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9168
9169 f->async_iconified = 1;
9170 f->async_visible = 0;
9171
9172
9173 BLOCK_INPUT;
9174 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9175 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9176 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9177
9178 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9179 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9180 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9181 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9182 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9183 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9184
9185 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9186 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9187
9188 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9189 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9190 {
9191 XEvent message;
9192
9193 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9194 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9195 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9196 message.xclient.format = 32;
9197 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9198
9199 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9200 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9201 False,
9202 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9203 &message))
9204 {
9205 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9206 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9207 }
9208 }
9209
9210 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9211 IconicState. */
9212 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9213
9214 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9215 {
9216 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9217 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9218 }
9219
9220 f->async_iconified = 1;
9221 f->async_visible = 0;
9222
9223 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9225 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9226 }
9227
9228 \f
9229 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9230
9231 void
9232 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9233 {
9234 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9235 Lisp_Object bar;
9236 struct scroll_bar *b;
9237
9238 BLOCK_INPUT;
9239
9240 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9241 commands to the X server. */
9242 if (dpyinfo->display)
9243 {
9244 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9245 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9246 face. */
9247 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9248 free_frame_faces (f);
9249
9250 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9251 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9252
9253 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9254 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9255 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9256 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9257 toolkit scroll bars. */
9258 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9259 {
9260 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9261 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9262 }
9263 #endif
9264
9265 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9266 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9267 free_frame_xic (f);
9268 #endif
9269
9270 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9271 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9272 {
9273 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9274 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9275 }
9276 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9277 we are using a toolkit. */
9278 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9279 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9280
9281 free_frame_menubar (f);
9282 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9283
9284 #ifdef USE_GTK
9285 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9286 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9287
9288 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9289 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9290 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9291
9292 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9293 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9294 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9295 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9296 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9297 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9298
9299 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9300 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9301 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9302 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9303 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9304 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9305 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9306 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9307 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9308 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9309 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9310 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9311 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9312 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9313 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9314
9315 x_free_gcs (f);
9316 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9317 }
9318
9319 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9320 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9321 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9322
9323 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9324 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9325 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9326 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9327 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9328 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9329
9330 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9331 {
9332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9333 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9334 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9335 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9336 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9337 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9338 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9339 }
9340
9341 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9342 }
9343
9344
9345 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9346
9347 void
9348 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9349 {
9350 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9351
9352 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9353 commands to the X server. */
9354 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9355 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9356
9357 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9358 }
9359
9360 \f
9361 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9362
9363 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9364 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9365 that the window now has.
9366 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9367 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9368 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9369
9370 #ifndef USE_GTK
9371 void
9372 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9373 {
9374 XSizeHints size_hints;
9375 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9376
9377 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9378 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9379
9380 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9381 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9382
9383 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9384 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9385
9386 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9387 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9388 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9389 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9390 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9391 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9392
9393 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9394 {
9395 int base_width, base_height;
9396 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9397
9398 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9399 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9400
9401 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9402
9403 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9404 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9405 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9406 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9407 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9408
9409 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9410 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9411 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9412
9413 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9414 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9415 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9416 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9417 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9418 }
9419
9420 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9421 if (flags)
9422 {
9423 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9424 goto no_read;
9425 }
9426
9427 {
9428 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9429 long supplied_return;
9430 int value;
9431
9432 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9433 &supplied_return);
9434
9435 if (flags)
9436 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9437 else
9438 {
9439 if (value == 0)
9440 hints.flags = 0;
9441 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9442 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9443 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9444 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9445 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9446 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9447 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9448 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9449 }
9450 }
9451
9452 no_read:
9453
9454 #ifdef PWinGravity
9455 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9456 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9457
9458 if (user_position)
9459 {
9460 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9461 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9462 }
9463 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9464
9465 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9466 }
9467 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9468
9469 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9470
9471 void
9472 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9473 {
9474 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9475 Arg al[1];
9476
9477 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9478 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9479 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9480 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9481
9482 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9483 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9484
9485 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9486 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9487 }
9488
9489 void
9490 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9491 {
9492 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9493
9494 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9495 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9496 #endif
9497
9498 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9499 {
9500 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9501 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9502 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9503 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9504 }
9505 else
9506 {
9507 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9508 pixmap. */
9509 return;
9510 }
9511
9512
9513 #ifdef USE_GTK
9514 {
9515 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9516 return;
9517 }
9518
9519 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9520
9521 {
9522 Arg al[1];
9523 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9524 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9525 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9526 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9527 }
9528
9529 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9530
9531 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9532 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9533
9534 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9535 }
9536
9537 void
9538 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9539 {
9540 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9541
9542 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9543 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9544 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9545
9546 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9547 }
9548
9549 \f
9550 /***********************************************************************
9551 Fonts
9552 ***********************************************************************/
9553
9554 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9555
9556 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9557 font table. */
9558
9559 static void
9560 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9561 {
9562 Lisp_Object frame;
9563
9564 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9565 if (font->driver->check)
9566 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9567 }
9568
9569 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9570
9571 \f
9572 /***********************************************************************
9573 Initialization
9574 ***********************************************************************/
9575
9576 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9577 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9578 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9579 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9580
9581 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9582 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9583 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9584
9585 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9586 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9587 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9588 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9589 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9590 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9591 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9592 };
9593
9594 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9595
9596 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9597
9598 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9599
9600 static int x_initialized;
9601
9602 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9603 static int x_session_initialized;
9604 #endif
9605
9606 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9607 the screen number from the server number. */
9608 static int
9609 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9610 {
9611 int seen_colon = 0;
9612 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9613 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9614 int length_until_period = 0;
9615
9616 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9617 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9618 length_until_period++;
9619
9620 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9621 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9622 name1 += 4;
9623 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9624 name2 += 4;
9625 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9626 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9627 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9628 name1 += system_name_length;
9629 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9630 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9631 name2 += system_name_length;
9632 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9633 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9634 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9635 name1 += length_until_period;
9636 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9637 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9638 name2 += length_until_period;
9639
9640 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9641 {
9642 if (*name1 == ':')
9643 seen_colon++;
9644 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9645 return 1;
9646 }
9647 return (seen_colon
9648 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9649 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9650 }
9651
9652 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9653 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9654 to 5. */
9655 static void
9656 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9657 {
9658 int nr = 0;
9659 int off = 0;
9660
9661 while (!(mask & 1))
9662 {
9663 off++;
9664 mask >>= 1;
9665 }
9666
9667 while (mask & 1)
9668 {
9669 nr++;
9670 mask >>= 1;
9671 }
9672
9673 *offset = off;
9674 *bits = nr;
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9678 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9679
9680 int
9681 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9682 {
9683 int dpy_ok = 1;
9684 Display *dpy;
9685
9686 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9687 if (dpy)
9688 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9689 else
9690 dpy_ok = 0;
9691 return dpy_ok;
9692 }
9693
9694 #ifdef USE_GTK
9695 static void
9696 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9697 {
9698 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9699 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9700 }
9701 #endif
9702
9703 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9704 the structure that describes the open display.
9705 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9706
9707 struct x_display_info *
9708 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9709 {
9710 int connection;
9711 Display *dpy;
9712 struct terminal *terminal;
9713 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9714 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9715
9716 BLOCK_INPUT;
9717
9718 if (!x_initialized)
9719 {
9720 x_initialize ();
9721 ++x_initialized;
9722 }
9723
9724 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9725 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9726
9727 #ifdef USE_GTK
9728 {
9729 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9730 int argc;
9731 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9732 char **argv2 = argv;
9733 guint id;
9734
9735 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9736 {
9737 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9738 }
9739 else
9740 {
9741 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9742 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9743
9744 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9745 argv[argc] = 0;
9746
9747 argc = 0;
9748 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9749
9750 if (! NILP (display_name))
9751 {
9752 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9753 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9754 }
9755
9756 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9757 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9758
9759 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9760
9761 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9762 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9763 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9764 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9765 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9766 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9767
9768 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9769 fixup_locale ();
9770 xg_initialize ();
9771
9772 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9773
9774 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9775 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9776
9777 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9778 {
9779 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9780 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9781
9782 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9783 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9784
9785 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9786 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9787 }
9788
9789 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9790 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9791 }
9792 }
9793 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9794 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9795 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9796 errors with X11R5:
9797 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9798 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9799 So let's not use it until R6. */
9800 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9801 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9802 #endif
9803
9804 {
9805 int argc = 0;
9806 char *argv[3];
9807
9808 argv[0] = "";
9809 argc = 1;
9810 if (xrm_option)
9811 {
9812 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9813 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9814 }
9815 turn_on_atimers (0);
9816 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
9817 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9818 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9819 &argc, argv);
9820 turn_on_atimers (1);
9821
9822 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9823 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9824 fixup_locale ();
9825 #endif
9826 }
9827
9828 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9829 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9830 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
9831 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9832 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9833
9834 /* Detect failure. */
9835 if (dpy == 0)
9836 {
9837 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9838 return 0;
9839 }
9840
9841 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9842
9843 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9844 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9845
9846 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9847
9848 {
9849 struct x_display_info *share;
9850 Lisp_Object tail;
9851
9852 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9853 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9854 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9855 SDATA (display_name)))
9856 break;
9857 if (share)
9858 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9859 else
9860 {
9861 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9862 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9863 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
9864
9865 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9866 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9867 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9868 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9869 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9870
9871 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9872 {
9873 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9874
9875 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9876 list of terminals. */
9877 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9878 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9879 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9880 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
9881
9882 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9883 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
9884 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9885 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
9886 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
9887 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
9888 BLOCK_INPUT;
9889 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
9890 terminal_list = terminal;
9891 UNGCPRO;
9892 }
9893
9894 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9895 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9896 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9897 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
9898 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
9899 }
9900 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
9901 }
9902
9903 /* Put this display on the chain. */
9904 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
9905 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
9906
9907 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
9908 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
9909 x_display_name_list);
9910 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
9911
9912 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
9913
9914 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
9915 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
9916 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
9917 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
9918
9919 #if 0
9920 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
9921 #endif /* ! 0 */
9922
9923 dpyinfo->x_id_name
9924 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
9925 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
9926 + 2);
9927 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
9928 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
9929
9930 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
9931 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
9932
9933 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
9934 #ifdef USE_GTK
9935 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
9936 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
9937 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9938
9939 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
9940 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
9941
9942 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
9943 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
9944 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
9945 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
9946 #else
9947 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
9948 #endif
9949 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
9950 all versions. */
9951 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
9952
9953 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
9954 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
9955 select_visual (dpyinfo);
9956 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
9957 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
9958 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
9959 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
9960 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
9961 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
9962 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
9963 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
9964 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
9965 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
9966 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
9967 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9968 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9969 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9970 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9971 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
9972 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9973 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
9974 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
9975 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
9976 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
9977 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9978 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9979 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9980 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
9981
9982 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
9983 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
9984 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
9985
9986 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
9987 {
9988 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
9989 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
9990 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
9991 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
9992 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
9993 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
9994 }
9995
9996 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
9997 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
9998 {
9999 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10000 {
10001 Lisp_Object value;
10002 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10003 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10004 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10005 Qnil, Qnil);
10006 if (STRINGP (value)
10007 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10008 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10009 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10010 }
10011 }
10012 else
10013 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10014 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10015
10016 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10017 {
10018 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10019 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10020 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10021 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10022 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10023 for example). */
10024 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10025 double d;
10026 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10027 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10028 }
10029 #endif
10030
10031 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10032 {
10033 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10034 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10035 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10036 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10037 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10038 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10039 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10040 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10041 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10042 }
10043
10044 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10045 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10046 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10047 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10048 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10049 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10050 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10051 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10052 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10053 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10054 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10055 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10056 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10057 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10058 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10059 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10060 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10061 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10062 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10063 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10064 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10065 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10066 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10067 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10068 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10069 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10070 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10071 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10072 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10073 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10074 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10075 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10076 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10077 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10078 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10079 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10080 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10081 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10082 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10083 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10084 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10085 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10086 /* For properties of font. */
10087 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10088 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10089 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10090 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10091 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10092 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10093 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10094 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10095 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10096 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10097
10098 /* Ghostscript support. */
10099 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10100 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10101
10102 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10103 False);
10104
10105 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
10106 False);
10107
10108 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state
10109 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE", False);
10110 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom
10111 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", False);
10112 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
10113 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ", False);
10114 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
10115 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT", False);
10116 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
10117 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", False);
10118 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type
10119 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", False);
10120 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
10121 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP", False);
10122 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
10123 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", False);
10124 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name
10125 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_NAME", False);
10126
10127 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10128
10129 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10130 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10131 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10132 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10133
10134 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10135 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10136 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10137
10138 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10139 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10140
10141 {
10142 dpyinfo->gray
10143 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10144 gray_bitmap_bits,
10145 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10146 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10147 }
10148
10149 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10150 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10151 #endif
10152
10153 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10154
10155 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10156 if (connection != 0)
10157 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10158
10159 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10160 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10161 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10162
10163 #ifdef SIGIO
10164 if (interrupt_input)
10165 init_sigio (connection);
10166 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10167
10168 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10169 {
10170 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10171 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10172 Font font;
10173
10174 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10175 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10176 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10177 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10178 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10179 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10180 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10181 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10182 abort ();
10183 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10184 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10185 x_uncatch_errors ();
10186 }
10187 #endif
10188
10189 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10190 for debugging X code. */
10191 {
10192 Lisp_Object value;
10193 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10194 build_string ("synchronous"),
10195 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10196 Qnil, Qnil);
10197 if (STRINGP (value)
10198 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10199 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10200 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10201 }
10202
10203 {
10204 Lisp_Object value;
10205 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10206 build_string ("useXIM"),
10207 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10208 Qnil, Qnil);
10209 #ifdef USE_XIM
10210 if (STRINGP (value)
10211 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10212 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10213 use_xim = 0;
10214 #else
10215 if (STRINGP (value)
10216 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10217 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10218 use_xim = 1;
10219 #endif
10220 }
10221
10222 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10223 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10224 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10225 tty. */
10226 if (terminal->id == 1)
10227 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10228 #endif
10229
10230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10231
10232 return dpyinfo;
10233 }
10234 \f
10235 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10236 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10237
10238 void
10239 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10240 {
10241 struct terminal *t;
10242
10243 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10244 X display. */
10245 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10246 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10247 {
10248 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10249 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10250 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10251 x_session_close ();
10252 #endif
10253 delete_terminal (t);
10254 break;
10255 }
10256
10257 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10258
10259 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10260 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10261 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10262 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10263 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10264 else
10265 {
10266 Lisp_Object tail;
10267
10268 tail = x_display_name_list;
10269 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10270 {
10271 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10272 {
10273 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10274 break;
10275 }
10276 tail = XCDR (tail);
10277 }
10278 }
10279
10280 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10281 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10282
10283 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10284 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10285 else
10286 {
10287 struct x_display_info *tail;
10288
10289 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10290 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10291 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10292 }
10293
10294 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10295 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10296 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10297 xfree (dpyinfo);
10298 }
10299
10300 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10301
10302 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10303 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10304 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10305 that slows us down. */
10306
10307 static void
10308 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10309 {
10310 BLOCK_INPUT;
10311 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10312 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10313 {
10314 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10315 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10316 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10317 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10318 }
10319 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10320 }
10321
10322 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10323 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10324 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10325 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10326 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10327 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10328 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10329
10330 void
10331 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10332 {
10333 BLOCK_INPUT;
10334 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10335 {
10336 EMACS_TIME interval;
10337
10338 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10339 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10340 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10341 }
10342 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10343 }
10344
10345 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10346
10347 \f
10348 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10349
10350 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10351
10352 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10353 {
10354 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10355 x_produce_glyphs,
10356 x_write_glyphs,
10357 x_insert_glyphs,
10358 x_clear_end_of_line,
10359 x_scroll_run,
10360 x_after_update_window_line,
10361 x_update_window_begin,
10362 x_update_window_end,
10363 x_cursor_to,
10364 x_flush,
10365 #ifdef XFlush
10366 x_flush,
10367 #else
10368 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10369 #endif
10370 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10371 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10372 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10373 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10374 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10375 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10376 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10377 x_draw_glyph_string,
10378 x_define_frame_cursor,
10379 x_clear_frame_area,
10380 x_draw_window_cursor,
10381 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10382 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10383 };
10384
10385
10386 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10387 void
10388 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10389 {
10390 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10391
10392 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10393 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10394 if (!terminal->name)
10395 return;
10396
10397 BLOCK_INPUT;
10398 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10399 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10400 X display. */
10401 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10402 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10403 #endif
10404
10405 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10406 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10407 if (dpyinfo->display)
10408 {
10409 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10410 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10411
10412 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10413 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10414 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10415 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10416
10417 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10418 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10419 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10420 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10421 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10422 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10423 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10424 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10425 leaks in other situations. */
10426 #if 0
10427 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10428 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10429 #else
10430 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10431 #endif
10432 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10433 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10434 closing all the displays. */
10435 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10436 #endif
10437
10438 #ifdef USE_GTK
10439 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10440 #else
10441 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10442 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10443 #else
10444 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10445 #endif
10446 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10447 }
10448
10449 /* Mark as dead. */
10450 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10451 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10452 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10453 }
10454
10455 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10456 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10457
10458 static struct terminal *
10459 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10460 {
10461 struct terminal *terminal;
10462
10463 terminal = create_terminal ();
10464
10465 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10466 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10467 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10468
10469 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10470
10471 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10472 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10473 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10474 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10475 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10476 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10477 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10478 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10479 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10480 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10481 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10482 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10483 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10484 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10485 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10486 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10487 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10488 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10489 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10490 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10491
10492 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10493 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10494
10495 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10496 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10497 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10498 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10499 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10500 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10501 off the bottom. */
10502
10503 return terminal;
10504 }
10505
10506 void
10507 x_initialize (void)
10508 {
10509 baud_rate = 19200;
10510
10511 x_noop_count = 0;
10512 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10513 any_help_event_p = 0;
10514 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10515 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10516 x_session_initialized = 0;
10517 #endif
10518
10519 #ifdef USE_GTK
10520 current_count = -1;
10521 #endif
10522
10523 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10524 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10525
10526 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10527 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10528
10529 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10530
10531 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10532 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10533 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10534 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10535 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10536 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10537 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10538
10539 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10540 #endif
10541
10542 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10543 #ifndef USE_GTK
10544 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10545 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10546 #endif
10547 #endif
10548
10549 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10550 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10551 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10552
10553 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10554 original error handler. */
10555 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10556 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10557
10558 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10559
10560 xgselect_initialize ();
10561 }
10562
10563
10564 void
10565 syms_of_xterm (void)
10566 {
10567 x_error_message = NULL;
10568
10569 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10570 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10571
10572 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10573 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10574
10575 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10576 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10577
10578 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10579 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10580
10581 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10582 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10583
10584 #ifdef USE_GTK
10585 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10586 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10587
10588 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10589 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10590 #endif
10591
10592 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10593 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10594 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10595 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10596 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10597 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10598 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10599 sizes. */);
10600 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10601
10602 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10603 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10604 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10605 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10606 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10607 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10608 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10609
10610 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10611 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10612 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10613 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10614 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10615 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10616 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10617 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10618 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10619
10620 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10621 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10622 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10623 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10624 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10625 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10626 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10627 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10628 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10629 #elif USE_GTK
10630 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10631 #else
10632 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10633 #endif
10634 #else
10635 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10636 #endif
10637
10638 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10639 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10640
10641 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10642 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10643 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10644 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10645 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10646 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10647 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10648 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10649 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10650
10651 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10652 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10653 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10654 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10655 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10656 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10657
10658 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10659 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10660 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10661 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10662 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10663 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10664
10665 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10666 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10667 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10668 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10669 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10670 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10671
10672 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10673 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10674 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10675 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10676 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10677 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10678
10679 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10680 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10681 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10682 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10683 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10684 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10685 }
10686
10687 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10688
10689 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10690 (do not change this comment) */